Login| Sign Up| Help| Contact|

Patent Searching and Data


Title:
SYSTEM, APPARATUS AND METHOD FOR IMPROVED LOCATION IDENTIFICATION
Document Type and Number:
WIPO Patent Application WO/2024/073767
Kind Code:
A1
Abstract:
A prism for reflecting a laser includes: a single mounting cap at a first end of the prism, and first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

Inventors:
PINERO ALBERTO (US)
BUSHYEAGER WESTON (US)
ROY MAYANK (US)
BRYNER EDWARD A (US)
Application Number:
PCT/US2023/075691
Publication Date:
April 04, 2024
Filing Date:
October 02, 2023
Export Citation:
Click for automatic bibliography generation   Help
Assignee:
GECKO ROBOTICS INC (US)
International Classes:
G02B5/122; G02B17/08; H01Q15/18; G06V20/58
Attorney, Agent or Firm:
WILLS, J. Stephen et al. (US)
Download PDF:
Claims:
What is claimed is:

1. A prism for reflecting a laser, comprising: a single mounting cap at a first end of the prism; and first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each comprising a reflective surface comprising: three side edges; and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

2. The prism of claim 1, wherein the seventh TC reflector comprises a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap.

3. The prism of claim 2, wherein the first to sixth TC reflectors, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, are arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector and the mounting cap.

4. The prism of claim 3, wherein: for each of the first to third TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts the top surface of the mounting cap; and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts a side edge of the seventh TC reflector.

5. An apparatus, comprising: an inspection robot comprising: a body; and a prism for reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head, the prism comprising: a single mounting cap mounted on the body of the inspection robot at a first end of the prism; and first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each comprising a reflective surface comprising: three side edges; and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

6. The apparatus of claim 5, wherein the seventh TC reflector comprises a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap.

7. The apparatus of claim 6, wherein the first to sixth TC reflectors, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, are arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector and the mounting cap.

8. The apparatus of claim 7, wherein: for each of the first to third TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts the top surface of the mounting cap; and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts a side edge of the seventh TC reflector.

9. A method, comprising: providing a prism reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head, comprising: providing a single mounting cap mounted on a body of an inspection robot at a first end of the prism; and providing first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each comprising a reflective surface comprising: three side edges; and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

10. The method of claim 9, wherein the seventh TC reflector comprises a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap.

11. The method of claim 10, wherein the first to sixth TC reflectors, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, are arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector and the mounting cap.

12. The method of claim 11, wherein: for each of the first to third TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts the top surface of the mounting cap; and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts a side edge of the seventh TC reflector.

13. The method of claim 9, further comprising providing the prism on an inspection robot, the inspection robot comprising a body to which the mounting cap is mounted.

14. The method of claim 13, further comprising reflecting a laser from the laser tracking head on at least the seventh TC reflector.

15. The method of claim 13, further comprising further reflecting the laser from the laser tracking head on at least one of the first to sixth TC reflectors.

16. The method of claim 14, further comprising reflecting the laser from the laser tracking head within a reflective orientation coverage (ROC) map corresponding to a 1.5 plane prism model.

17. A prism for reflecting a laser beam, comprising: a mounting cap; and seven trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each comprising a reflective surface comprising: three side edges; and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seven TC reflectors are arranged such that: for each of a first three of the seven TC reflectors: a first side edge, among the three side edges, is in direct contact with and parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap; a first corner, among the three corners, is opposite to the first side edge; and a second comer and a third corner, among the three corners, directly contact another of the first three of the seven TC reflectors at first and second ends of the first side edge parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap; for each of a second three of the seven TC reflectors: a first corner, among the three corners, points toward the top surface of the mounting cap; a first side edge, among the three side edges, is parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap, and is opposite to the first corner; and a second comer and a third corner, among the three corners, directly contact another of the second three of the seven TC reflectors at first and second ends of the first side edge parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap, and are opposite to the first corner; and for a seventh of the seven TC reflectors: each of three side edges contacts a respective one of the first sides of the second three of the seven TC reflectors; and the reflective surface is parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap.

Description:
SYSTEM, APPARATUS AND METHOD FOR IMPROVED LOCATION IDENTIFICATION

CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS

[0001] This application claims priority to U.S. Provisional Application No.: 63/377,892 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-00017-P01), filed September 30, 2022, entitled “SYSTEM, APPARATUS AND METHOD FOR IMPROVED LOCATION IDENTIFICATION.”

[0002] This application is a continuation of U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 16/869,675 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007-U02-C06), filed May 8, 2020, entitled “SYSTEMS AND METHODS FOR DRIVING AN INSPECTION ROBOT WITH MOTOR HAVING MAGNETIC SHIELDING”, and published on August 20, 2020, as U.S. Publication 20200262052.

[0003] U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 16/869,675 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007-U02- C06) is a continuation of U.S Patent Application Serial No. 16/863,594 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007-U02), filed April 30, 2020, entitled “SYSTEM, METHOD, AND APPARATUS FOR RAPID DEVELOPMENT OF AN INSPECTION SCHEME FOR AN INSPECTION ROBOT”, and issued of November 29, 2022, as U.S. Patent 11,511,426.

[0004] U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 16/863,594 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007-U02) is a continuation of PCT Patent Application Serial No. PCT/US20/21779 (Attorney Docket No. GROB- 0007-WO), filed March 9, 2020, entitled “INSPECTION ROBOT”, and published on September 17, 2020, as WIPO publication No. WO 2020/185719

[0005] PCT Patent Application Serial No. PCT/US20/21779 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007- WO), is a continuation-in-part of U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 15/853,391 (Attorney Docket No. GRGB-0003-U01), filed December 22, 2017, entitled “INSPECTION ROBOT WITH COUPLANT CHAMBER DISPOSED WITHIN SLED FOR ACOUSTIC COUPLING”, and issued on June 10, 2020 as U.S. Patent 10,698,412.

[0006] U.S. Patent Application Serial No. 15/853,391 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0003-U01) claims the benefit of priority to the following U.S. Provisional Patent Applications: Serial No. 62/438,788 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0001-P01), filed December 23, 2016, entitled "STRUCTURE TRAVERSING ROBOT WITH INSPECTION FUNCTIONALITY"; and Serial No. 62/596,737 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0003-P01), filed December 8, 2017, entitled "METHOD AND APPARATUS TO INSPECT A SURFACE UTILIZING REAL-TIME POSITION INFORMATION".

[0007] PCT Patent Application Serial No. PCT/US20/21779 (Attorney Docket No. GROB-0007- WO), claims the benefit of priority to the following U.S. Provisional Patent Application Serial No. 62/815,724 (Attorney Docket No. GRGB-0005-P01), filed March 8, 2019, entitled “INSPECTION ROBOT.”

[0008] Each of the foregoing applications is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. BACKGROUND

[0009] The present disclosure relates to robotic inspection and treatment of industrial surfaces. These may be performed by a robotic total system (RTS) (or “robotic total station”). In the geospatial and land surveying industries, which are example industries in which RTS systems may be deployed, RTS systems are provided with a laser range finder tracking head along with what is known as an RTS prism. So long as the laser tracking head has line of sight with a single trihedral corner (TC) reflector, the TC reflector is oriented correctly, and it is within range, it can accurately plot a location in 3D space based on the location of the TC reflector. RTS prisms may be constructed with a single TC reflector or with several TC reflectors oriented to reflect all light from a singular point in free space. In an RTS system, the laser tracking head has a fixed (X, Y, Z) position. Additionally, the laser tracking head acts as the origin of a laser beam. The RTS prism, unlike the laser head, is free to move about 3-dimensional (“3D”) space while the distance and angle between the two are measured.

[0010] FIG. 90 is a schematic diagram of a traditional “360” RTS prism.

[0011] To finely track the motion of a crawler robot on 3D assets, RTS continuous tracking is utilized with an RTS prism permanently affixed to the crawler robot. Referring to FIG. 90, a 360° RTS prism 222100 includes six individual trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, i.e., first to sixth TC reflectors 222102, 222104, 222106, 222108, 222110, 222112 that are configured to reflect substantially all light from the center of the RTS prism 222100 (e.g., ±1.5 mm), a first mounting cap 222114 on a bottom of the RTS prism 222100, and a second mounting cap 222116 on a top of the RTS prism 222100. In the illustration of FIG. 90, the first TC reflector 222102 is on a left front of the RTS prism 222100; the second TC reflector 222104 is on a right front of the RTS prism 222100; the third TC reflector 222106 is on a front center of the RTS prism 222100; the fourth TC reflector 222108 is on a left rear of the RTS prism 222100; the fifth TC reflector 222110 is on a right rear of the RTS prism 222100; and the sixth TC reflector 222112 is on a rear center of the RTS prism 222100. The mounting caps 222114, 222116 are on both of the top and bottom of the RTS prism 222100.

[0012] RTS continuous tracking samples and records points in 3D space at a predefined frequency. In this scenario, the RTS prism has a fixed (X, Y, Z) offset relative to the crawler robot, but the crawler robot is free to move about (X, Y, Z) coordinate space. This configuration allows an RTS system to track and record the motion of our crawler robot in 3D space. However, traditional 360 RTS prisms have limited reflective orientation coverage (ROC) maps. Analyzing the ROC map for a 360° RTS prism shows it is effectively limited to a single plane. This is not adequate for use cases in which the orientation of the prism can change to a large degree while using continuous tracking, for example, across curved surfaces.

[0013] FIG. 91A is a schematic diagram of a 3D line-of-sight coverage area for the prism of FIG. 90. FIG. 91B is a section view of the 3D line-of-sight coverage area of FIG. 91A.

[0014] Testing has shown that traditional “360” RTS prisms do not provide adequate line-of-sight coverage. 360° prisms only provide true 360° coverage in a single plane. In other words, traditional “360” robotic total system (RTS) (or “robotic total station”) laser prisms are limited in their line-of- sight coverage to a singular plane. The resultant orientation coverage map resembles a torus stretching to a center point. These prisms have mounting caps on both ends. This prevents direct line-of-sight coverage on both the top and bottom. When crawling on assets with curves, or other changing geometries, such as on/in the hull of a ship or in/on a pipe, the RTS prism will often orient itself outside the bounds of its resultant ROC map. It should be appreciated that the aforementioned hull of a ship and pipe locations are non-limiting examples. This leads to a loss in line of sight with the laser tracking head. Referring to FIG. 91A, traditional 360° prisms create an ROC map 223102 that resembles a modified torus stretching to a center point. Referring to FIG. 91B, which is a section view of the ROC map 223102 of FIG. 91 A, a line-of-sight coverage is shown in areas 223104, 223106, and a loss in coverage is depicted in area 223108. There is no line-of-sight coverage above or below the planes of the mounting caps 222114, 222116 that are in contact with the first to sixth TC reflectors 222102, 222104, 222106, 222108, 222110, 222112.

[0015] Accordingly, there is a need for RTS prisms with improved direct line-of-sight coverage. SUMMARY

[0016] Previously known inspection and treatment systems for industrial surfaces suffer from a number of drawbacks. Industrial surfaces are often required to be inspected to determine whether a pipe wall, tank surface, or other industrial surface feature has suffered from corrosion, degradation, loss of a coating, damage, wall thinning or wear, or other undesirable aspects. Industrial surfaces are often present within a hazardous location - for example in an environment with heavy operating equipment, operating at high temperatures, in a confined environment, at a high elevation, in the presence of high voltage electricity, in the presence of toxic or noxious gases, in the presence of corrosive liquids, and/or in the presence of operating equipment that is dangerous to personnel. Accordingly, presently known systems require that a system be shutdown, that a system be operated at a reduced capacity, that stringent safety procedures be followed (e.g., lockout/tagout, confined space entry procedures, harnessing, etc.), and/or that personnel are exposed to hazards even if proper procedures are followed. Additionally, the inconvenience, hazards, and/or confined spaces of personnel entry into inspection areas can result in inspections that are incomplete, of low resolution, that lack systematic coverage of the inspected area, and/or that are prone to human error and judgement in determining whether an area has been properly inspected.

[0017] Embodiments of the present disclosure provide for systems and methods of inspecting an inspection surface with an improved inspection robot. Example embodiments include modular drive assemblies that are selectively coupled to a chassis of the inspection robot, wherein each drive assembly may have distinct wheels suited to different types of inspection surfaces. Other embodiments include payloads selectively couplable to the inspection robot chassis via universal connectors that provide for the exchange of couplant, electrical power and/or data communications. The payload may each have different sensor configurations suited for interrogating different types of inspection surfaces.

[0018] Embodiments of the present disclosure may provide for improved customer responsiveness by generating interactive inspection maps that depict past, present and/or predicted inspection data of an inspection surface. In embodiments, the inspection maps may be transmitted and displayed on user electronic devices and may provide for control of the inspection robot during an inspection run. [0019] Embodiments of the present disclosure may provide for an inspection robot with improved environmental capabilities. For example, some embodiments have features for operating in hostile environments, e.g., high temperature environments. Such embodiments may include low operational impact capable cooling systems.

[0020] Embodiments of the present disclosure may provide for an inspection robot having an improved, e.g., reduced, footprint which may further provide for increased climbing of inclined and/or vertical inspection surfaces. The reduced footprint of certain embodiments may also provide for inspection robots having improved the horizontal range due to reduced weight.

[0021] Embodiments of the present disclosure may provide for greater line-of-sight coverage for an RTS prism than a traditional “360” RTS system. Embodiments of the present disclosure may replace one of the mounting caps of a traditional “360” RTS system with an additional reflector. The resultant coverage map may resemble a hemisphere, rather than the traditional stretched torus. The single-reflector addition may increase the prism’s reflecting coverage to 1.5 planes. This may provide full coverage when mounted normal to a surface, for example, when mounted on an inspection robot.

[0022] In an aspect, a prism for reflecting a laser may include: a single mounting cap at a first end of the prism, and first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

[0023] In an aspect, an apparatus may include: an inspection robot including: a body, and a prism for reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head, the prism including: a single mounting cap mounted on the body of the inspection robot at a first end of the prism, and first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

[0024] In an aspect, a method may include: providing a prism reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head, including: providing a single mounting cap mounted on the body of the inspection robot at a first end of the prism, and providing first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism.

[0025] In an aspect, a prism for reflecting a laser beam may include: a mounting cap, and seven trihedral comer (TC) reflectors, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seven TC reflectors are arranged such that: for each of a first three of the seven TC reflectors: a first side edge, among the three side edges, is in direct contact with and parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap, a first corner, among the three comers, is opposite to the first side, and a second corner and a third corner, among the three corners, directly contact another of the first three of the seven TC reflectors at first and second ends of the first side edge parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap; for each of a second three of the seven TC reflectors: a first comer, among the three corners, points toward the top surface of the mounting cap, a first side edge, among the three side edges, is parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap, and is opposite to the first corner, and a second corner and a third corner, among the three comers, directly contact another of the second three of the seven TC reflectors at first and second ends of the first side edge parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap, and are opposite to the first corner; and for a seventh of the seven TC reflectors: each of three side edges contacts a respective one of the first sides of the second three of the seven TC reflectors, and the reflective surface is parallel to the top surface of the mounting cap. BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES

[0026] FIG. 1 is a schematic depiction of an inspection robot consistent with certain embodiments of the present disclosure.

[0027] FIG. 2 is a schematic depiction of an inspection surface.

[0028] FIG. 3 is a schematic depiction of an inspection robot positioned on an inspection surface.

[0029] FIG. 4 is a schematic depiction of a location on an inspection surface.

[0030] FIG. 5 is a schematic block diagram of an apparatus for providing an inspection map.

[0031] FIG. 6 depicts an illustrative inspection map.

[0032] FIG. 7 depicts an illustrative inspection map and focus data.

[0033] FIG. 8 is a schematic block diagram of an apparatus for adjusting a trailing sensor configuration.

[0034] FIG. 9 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure to adjust a trailing sensor configuration.

[0035] FIG. 10 is a schematic block diagram of an apparatus for providing position informed inspection data.

[0036] FIG. 11 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure to provide position informed inspection data.

[0037] FIG. 12 is a schematic flow diagram of another procedure to provide position informed inspection data.

[0038] FIG. 13 is a schematic block diagram of an apparatus for providing a facility wear value.

[0039] FIG. 14 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure to provide a facility wear value.

[0040] FIG. 15 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure to re-process sensor data based on an induction process parameter.

[0041] FIG. 16 is a schematic block diagram of a procedure to utilize a shape description.

[0042] FIG. 17 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure to adjust an inspection operation in response to profiler data.

[0043] FIG. 18 depicts a schematic of an example system including a base station and an inspection robot.

[0044] FIG. 19 depicts a schematic of a power module in a base station.

[0045] FIG. 20 depicts an internal view of certain components of the center module.

[0046] FIG. 21 depicts an example bottom surface of the center module.

[0047] FIG. 22 depicts an exploded view of a cold plate on the bottom surface of the center module.

[0048] FIG. 23 depicts a payload with sensor carriages and an inspection camera.

[0049] FIGS. 24A depicts an example side view of a pay load and inspection camera.

[0050] FIGS. 24B-24C depict details of an example inspection camera. [0051] FIG. 25 depicts a schematic block diagram of a control scheme for an inspection robot.

[0052] FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram of a system for distributed control of an inspection robot.

[0053] FIG. 27 is a schematic diagram of an inspection robot supporting modular component operations.

[0054] FIG. 28 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure for operating an inspection robot.

[0055] FIG. 29 is a schematic diagram of a system for distributed control of an inspection robot.

[0056] FIG. 30 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure for operating an inspection robot having distributed control.

[0057] FIG. 31 is a flow chart depicting a method of inspecting an inspection surface with an inspection robot.

[0058] FIG. 32 is a flow chart depicting another method of inspecting an inspection surface with an inspection robot.

[0059] FIG. 33 is a flow chart depicting another method of inspecting an inspection surface with an inspection robot.

[0060] FIG. 34 depicts a controller for an inspection robot.

[0061] FIG. 35 depicts a method for dynamic adjustment of a biasing force for an inspection robot.

[0062] FIG. 36 depicts a method to determine a force adjustment to a biasing force of an inspection robot.

[0063] FIG. 37 depicts an inspection robot with multiple quick release interfaces.

[0064] FIG. 38 depicts an inspection robot having swappable and reversible drive modules.

[0065] FIG. 39 is another schematic depicting an inspection robot having one or more features for operating in a hazardous environment.

[0066] FIG. 40 depicts an embodiment of an inspection robot with a tether.

[0067] FIG. 41 depicts a method of releasably coupling an electrical interface and a mechanical interface of a modular drive assembly.

[0068] FIG. 42 depicts an example inspection robot with a drive piston couplable to a drive module.

[0069] FIG. 43 an example system with multiple drive pistons.

[0070] FIG. 44 depicts an example procedure for operating a robot having a multi-function piston coupling a drive module to a center chassis.

[0071] FIG. 45 depicts a system for inspection of an uneven inspection surface.

[0072] FIG. 46 depicts an example stability module assembly.

[0073] FIG. 47 is a schematic diagram of a gear box.

[0074] FIG. 48 depicts a schematic block diagram of a modular drive assembly.

[0075] FIG. 49 depicts a method for determining an alarm value based. [0076] FIG. 50 is a schematic diagram of an example system for controlling movement of an inspection robot.

[0077] FIG. 51 depicts an example controller to configure an inspection robot.

[0078] FIG. 52 depicts examples of configuration data.

[0079] FIG. 53 56 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure for configuring an inspection robot.

[0080] FIG. 54 depicts an example controller configured to perform operations for rapid response to inspection data.

[0081] FIG. 55 is a schematic diagram of an example system for rapid response to inspection data.

[0082] FIG. 56 is a schematic flow diagram of a procedure for rapid response to inspection data.

[0083] FIG. 57 is a schematic diagram of a system for traversing an obstacle with an inspection robot.

[0084] FIG. 58 is a flow chart depicting a method for traversing an obstacle with an inspection robot.

[0085] FIG. 59 is another flow chart depicting the method for traversing the obstacle with the inspection robot.

[0086] FIG. 60 depicts an apparatus for performing an inspection on an inspection surface with an inspection robot.

[0087] FIG. 61 and FIG. 62 depict an inspection map with features of the inspection surface and corresponding locations on the inspection surface.

[0088] FIG. 63 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map depicting one or more features in one or more frames.

[0089] FIG. 64 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map depicting one or more features in one or more frames in a pop-up portion.

[0090] FIG. 65 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map depicting one or more features in one or more frames in a pop-up portion with a pop-up graph.

[0091] FIG. 66 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map depicting one or more features in one or more frames in a pop-up portion with a pop-up graph.

[0092] FIG. 67 depicts a method for performing an inspection on an inspection surface with an inspection robot.

[0093] FIG. 68 is a schematic diagram of a controller for an inspection robot.

[0094] FIG. 69 is a schematic diagram depicting data structure used by embodiments of the controller of FIG. 68.

[0095] FIG. 70 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map.

[0096] FIG. 71 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map.

[0097] FIG. 72 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map. [0098] FIG. 73 is a schematic diagram of an inspection map.

[0099] FIG. 74 is a flow chart depicting a method for providing an interactive inspection map. [00100] FIG. 75 is a schematic diagram of a controller providing an interactive inspection map. [00101] FIG. 76 is a schematic diagram of a user focus value and an action command value utilized by embodiments of the controller of FIG. 75.

[00102] FIG. 77 is a flow chart depicting a method for inspecting and/or repairing an inspection surface.

[00103] FIG. 78 is a schematic diagram of an example system for providing real-time processed inspection data to a user.

[00104] FIG. 79 schematic diagram of an example controller for user interface.

[00105] FIG. 80 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to adjust an inspection operation.

[00106] FIG. 81 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to adjust inspection traversal and/or interrogation commands.

[00107] FIG. 82 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to enable additional inspection operations.

[00108] FIG. 83 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to adjust inspection traversal and/or interrogation commands.

[00109] FIG. 84 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to provide repair operations.

[00110] FIG. 85 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure to provide virtual marking operations.

[00111] FIG. 86 is a schematic diagram of a system to provide a user interface for interacting with the operations of a controller.

[00112] FIG. 87 a schematic diagram of a controller for performing operations to rapidly validate inspection data.

[00113] FIG. 88 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure for providing offset data to a user device.

[00114] FIG. 89 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure for providing metadata to a user device.

[00115] FIG. 90 is a schematic diagram of a traditional “360” RTS prism.

[00116] FIG. 91 A is a schematic diagram of a 3D line-of-sight coverage area for the traditional “360” RTS prism of FIG. 90.

[00117] FIG. 91B is a section view of the 3D line-of-sight coverage area of FIG. 91A. [00118] FIG. 92 is a schematic diagram of an RTS prism in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure.

[00119] FIG. 93A is a schematic diagram of a 3D line-of-sight coverage area for the RTS prism of FIG. 92.

[00120] FIG. 93B is a section view of the 3D line-of-sight coverage area of FIG. 93A. [00121] FIG. 94 is a schematic diagram of an apparatus having a body and an RTS prism. [00122] FIG. 95 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure for tracking an inspection robot.

[00123] FIG. 96 is a schematic flow diagram of an example procedure for tracking an inspection robot.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

[00124] The present disclosure relates to a system developed for traversing, climbing, or otherwise traveling over walls (curved or flat), or other industrial surfaces. Industrial surfaces, as described herein, include any tank, pipe, housing, or other surface utilized in an industrial environment, including at least heating and cooling pipes, conveyance pipes or conduits, and tanks, reactors, mixers, or containers. In certain embodiments, an industrial surface is ferromagnetic, for example including iron, steel, nickel, cobalt, and alloys thereof. In certain embodiments, an industrial surface is not ferromagnetic.

[00125] Certain descriptions herein include operations to inspect a surface, an inspection robot or inspection device, or other descriptions in the context of performing an inspection. Inspections, as utilized herein, should be understood broadly. Without limiting any other disclosures or embodiments herein, inspection operations herein include operating one or more sensors in relation to an inspected surface, electromagnetic radiation inspection of a surface (e.g., operating a camera) whether in the visible spectrum or otherwise (e.g., infrared, UV, X-Ray, gamma ray, etc.), high- resolution inspection of the surface itself (e.g., a laser profiler, caliper, etc.), performing a repair operation on a surface, performing a cleaning operation on a surface, and/or marking a surface for a later operation (e.g., for further inspection, for repair, and/or for later analysis). Inspection operations include operations for a payload carrying a sensor or an array of sensors (e.g. on sensor sleds) for measuring characteristics of a surface being traversed such as thickness of the surface, curvature of the surface, ultrasound (or ultra-sonic) measurements to test the integrity of the surface and/or the thickness of the material forming the surface, heat transfer, heat profile/mapping, profiles or mapping any other parameters, the presence of rust or other corrosion, surface defects or pitting, the presence of organic matter or mineral deposits on the surface, weld quality and the like. Sensors may include magnetic induction sensors, acoustic sensors, laser sensors, LIDAR, a variety of image sensors, and the like. The inspection sled may carry a sensor for measuring characteristics near the surface being traversed such as emission sensors to test for gas leaks, air quality monitoring, radioactivity, the presence of liquids, electro-magnetic interference, visual data of the surface being traversed such as uniformity, reflectance, status of coatings such as epoxy coatings, wall thickness values or patterns, wear patterns, and the like. The term inspection sled may indicate one or more tools for repairing, welding, cleaning, applying a treatment or coating the surface being treated. Treatments and coatings may include rust proofing, sealing, painting, application of a coating, and the like. Cleaning and repairing may include removing debris, sealing leaks, patching cracks, and the like. The term inspection sled, sensor sled, and sled may be used interchangeably throughout the present disclosure.

[00126] In certain embodiments, for clarity of description, a sensor is described in certain contexts throughout the present disclosure, but it is understood explicitly that one or more tools for repairing, cleaning, and/or applying a treatment or coating to the surface being treated are likewise contemplated herein wherever a sensor is referenced. In certain embodiments, where a sensor provides a detected value (e.g., inspection data or the like), a sensor rather than a tool may be contemplated, and/or a tool providing a feedback value (e.g., application pressure, application amount, nozzle open time, orientation, etc.) may be contemplated as a sensor in such contexts.

[00127] Inspections are conducted with a robotic system 100 (e.g., an inspection robot, a robotic vehicle, etc.) which may utilize sensor sleds 1 and a sled array system 2 which enables accurate, selfaligning, and self- stabilizing contact with a surface (not shown) while also overcoming physical obstacles and maneuvering at varying or constant speeds. In certain embodiments, mobile contact of the system 100 with the surface includes a magnetic wheel 3. In certain embodiments, a sled array system 2 is referenced herein as a payload 2 - wherein a payload 2 is an arrangement of sleds 1 with sensor mounted thereon, and wherein, in certain embodiments, an entire payload 2 can be changed out as a unit. The utilization of payloads 2, in certain embodiments, allows for a pre-configured sensor array that provides for rapid re-configuration by swapping out the entire payload 2. In certain embodiments, sleds 1 and/or specific sensors on sleds 1, are changeable within a payload 2 to reconfigure the sensor array.

[00128] An example sensor sled 1 includes, without limitation, one or more sensors mounted thereon such that the sensor(s) is operationally couplable to an inspection surface in contact with a bottom surface of the corresponding one of the sleds. For example, the sled 1 may include a chamber or mounting structure, with a hole at the bottom of the sled 1 such that the sensor can maintain line- of-sight and/or acoustic coupling with the inspection surface. The sled 1 as described throughout the present disclosure is mounted on and/or operationally coupled to the inspection robot 100 such that the sensor maintains a specified alignment to the inspection surface 500 - for example a perpendicular arrangement to the inspection surface, or any other specified angle. In certain embodiments, a sensor mounted on a sled 1 may have a line-of-sight or other detecting arrangement to the inspection surface that is not through the sled 1 - for example a sensor may be mounted at a front or rear of a sled 1, mounted on top of a sled 1 (e.g., having a view of the inspection surface that is forward, behind, to a side, and/or oblique to the sled 1). It will be seen that, regardless of the sensing orientation of the sensor to the inspection surface, maintenance of the sled 1 orientation to the inspection surface will support more consistent detection of the inspection surface by the sensor, and/or sensed values (e.g., inspection data) that is more consistently comparable over the inspection surface and/or that has a meaningful position relationship compared to position information determined for the sled 1 or inspection robot 100. In certain embodiments, a sensor may be mounted on the inspection robot 100 and/or a payload 2 - for example a camera mounted on the inspection robot 100.

[00129] The present disclosure allows for gathering of structural information from a physical structure. Example physical structures include industrial structures such as boilers, pipelines, tanks, ferromagnetic structures, and other structures. An example system 100 is configured for climbing the outside of tube walls.

[00130] As described in greater detail below, in certain embodiments, the disclosure provides a system that is capable of integrating input from sensors and sensing technology that may be placed on a robotic vehicle. The robotic vehicle is capable of multi-directional movement on a variety of surfaces, including flat walls, curved surfaces, ceilings, and/or floors (e.g., a tank bottom, a storage tank floor, and/or a recovery boiler floor). The ability of the robotic vehicle to operate in this way provides unique access especially to traditionally inaccessible or dangerous places, thus permitting the robotic vehicle to gather information about the structure it is climbing on.

[00131] The system 100 (e.g., an inspection robot, a robotic vehicle, and/or supporting devices such as external computing devices, couplant or fluid reservoirs and delivery systems, etc.) in FIG. 1 includes the sled 1 mounted on a payload 2 to provide for an array of sensors having selectable contact (e.g., orientation, down force, sensor spacing from the surface, etc.) with an inspected surface. The payload 2 includes mounting posts mounted to a main body 102 of the system 100. The pay load 2 thereby provides a convenient mounting position for a number of sleds 1, allowing for multiple sensors to be positioned for inspection in a single traverse of the inspected surface. The number and distance of the sleds 1 on the payload 2 are readily adjustable - for example by sliding the sled mounts on the payload 2 to adjust spacing. An example sled 1 has an aperture, for example to provide for couplant communication (e.g., an acoustically and/or optically continuous path of couplant) between the sensor mounted on the sled 1 and a surface to be inspected, to provide for line-of-sight availability between the sensor and the surface, or the like.

[00132] An example system 100 includes the sled 1 that is connected to the payload 2 (e.g., a sensor array or sensor suite). An example system includes the sled 1 coupled to the arm at a pivot point, allowing the sensor sled to rotate and/or tilt. On top of the arm, an example payload 2 includes a biasing member (e.g., a torsion spring) with another pivot point, which provides for a selectable down- force of the arm to the surface being inspected, and for an additional degree of freedom in sled 1 movement to ensure the sled 1 orients in a desired manner to the surface. In certain embodiments, down- force provides for at least a partial seal between the sensor sled 1 and surface to reduce or control couplant loss (e.g., where couplant loss is an amount of couplant consumed that is beyond what is required for operations), control distance between the sensor and the surface, and/or to ensure orientation of the sensor relative to the surface. Additionally or alternatively, the arm can lift in the presence of an obstacle, while traversing between surfaces, or the like, and return to the desired position after the maneuver is completed. In certain embodiments, an additional pivot couples the arm to the pay load 2, allowing for an additional rolling motion. In certain embodiments, pivots provide for three degrees of freedom on arm motion, allowing the arm to be responsive to almost any obstacle or surface shape for inspection operations. In certain embodiments, various features of the system 100, including one or more pivots co-operate to provide self-alignment of the sled 1 (and thus, the sensor mounted on the sled) to the surface. In certain embodiments, the sled 1 self-aligns to a curved surface and/or to a surface having variability in the surface shape.

[00133] In certain embodiments, the system is also able to collect information at multiple locations at once. This may be accomplished through the use of a sled array system. Modular in design, the sled array system allows for mounting sensor mounts, like the sleds, in fixed positions to ensure thorough coverage over varying contours. Furthermore, the sled array system allows for adjustment in spacing between sensors, adjustments of sled angle, and traveling over obstacles. In certain embodiments, the sled array system was designed to allow for multiplicity, allowing sensors to be added to or removed from the design, including changes in the type, quantity, and/or physical sensing arrangement of sensors. The sensor sleds that may be employed within the context of the present invention may house different sensors for diverse modalities useful for inspection of a structure. These sensor sleds are able to stabilize, align, travel over obstacles, and control, reduce, or optimize couplant delivery which allows for improved sensor feedback, reduced couplant loss, reduced post-inspection clean-up, reduced down-time due to sensor re-runs or bad data, and/or faster return to service for inspected equipment. [00134] There may be advantages to maintaining a sled with associated sensors or tools in contact and/or in a fixed orientation relative to the surface being traversed even when that surface is contoured, includes physical features, obstacles, and the like. In embodiments, there may be sled assemblies which are self-aligning to accommodate variabilities in the surface being traversed (e.g., an inspection surface) while maintaining the bottom surface of the sled (and/or a sensor or tool, e.g. where the sensor or tool protrudes through or is flush with a bottom surface of the sled) in contact with the inspection surface and the sensor or tool in a fixed orientation relative to the inspection surface. In an embodiment there may be a number of payloads 2, each payload 2 including a sled 1 positioned between a pair of sled arms, with each side exterior of the sled 1 attached to one end of each of the sled arms at a pivot point so that the sled 1 is able to rotate around an axis that would run between the pivot points on each side of the sled 1. As described elsewhere herein, the pay load 2 may include one or more inspection sleds 1 being pushed ahead of the payload 2, pulled behind the payload 2, or both. The other end of each sled arm is attached to an inspection sled mount 14 with a pivot connection which allows the sled arms to rotate around an axis running through the inspection sled mount 14 between the two pivot connections. Accordingly, each pair of sled arms can raise or lower independently from other sled arms, and with the corresponding sled 1. The inspection sled mount attaches to the payload 2, for example by mounting on shaft. The inspection sled mount may connect to the payload shaft with a connection which allows the sled 1 and corresponding arms to rotate from side to side in an arc around a perpendicular to the shaft. Together the up and down and side to side arc, where present, allow two degrees of rotational freedom to the sled arms A gimbal mount or any type of connection providing a rotational degree of freedom for movement is contemplated herein, as well as embodiments that do not include a rotational degree of freedom for movement. The gimbal mount allows the sled 1 and associated arms to rotate to accommodate side to side variability in the surface being traversed or obstacles on one side of the sled 1. The pivot points between the sled arms and the sled 1 allow the sled 1 to rotate (e.g., tilt in the direction of movement of the inspection robot 100) to conform to the surface being traversed and accommodate to variations or obstacles in the surface being traversed. Pivot points, together with the rotational freedom of the arms, provides the sled with three degrees of rotational freedom relative to the inspection surface. The ability to conform to the surface being traversed facilitated the maintenance of a perpendicular interface between the sensor and the surface allowing for improved interaction between the sled 1 and the inspection surface. Improved interaction may include ensuring that the sensor is operationally couplable to the inspection surface.

[00135] Within the inspection sled mount there may be a biasing member (e.g., torsion spring) which provides a down force to the sled 1 and corresponding arms. In the example, the down force is selectable by changing the torsion spring, and/or by adjusting the configuration of the torsion spring (e.g., confining or rotating the torsion spring to increase or decrease the down force). Analogous operations or structures to adjust the down force for other biasing members (e.g., a cylindrical spring, actuator for active down force control, etc.) are contemplated herein.

[00136] In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 includes a tether (not shown) to provide power, couplant or other fluids, and/or communication links to the robot 100. It has been demonstrated that a tether to support at least 200 vertical feet of climbing can be created, capable of couplant delivery to multiple ultra-sonic sensors, sufficient power for the robot, and sufficient communication for real-time processing at a computing device remote from the robot. Certain aspects of the disclosure herein, such as but not limited to utilizing couplant conservation features such as sled downforce configurations, the acoustic cone, and water as a couplant, support an extended length of tether. In certain embodiments, multiple ultra-sonic sensors can be provided with sufficient couplant through a 1/8” couplant delivery line, and/or through a 14” couplant delivery line to the inspection robot 100, with 1/8” final delivery lines to individual sensors. While the inspection robot 100 is described as receiving power, couplant, and communications through a tether, any or all of these, or other aspects utilized by the inspection robot 100 (e.g., paint, marking fluid, cleaning fluid, repair solutions, etc.) may be provided through a tether or provided in situ on the inspection robot 100. For example, the inspection robot 100 may utilize batteries, a fuel cell, and/or capacitors to provide power; a couplant reservoir and/or other fluid reservoir on the robot to provide fluids utilized during inspection operations, and/or wireless communication of any type for communications, and/or store data in a memory location on the robot for utilization after an inspection operation or a portion of an inspection operation.

[00137] In certain embodiments, maintaining sleds 1 (and sensors or tools mounted thereupon) in contact and/or selectively oriented (e.g., perpendicular) to a surface being traversed provides for: reduced noise, reduced lost-data periods, fewer false positives, and/or improved quality of sensing; and/or improved efficacy of tools associated with the sled (less time to complete a repair, cleaning, or marking operation; lower utilization of associated fluids therewith; improved confidence of a successful repair, cleaning, or marking operation, etc.). In certain embodiments, maintaining sleds 1 in contacts and/or selectively oriented to the surface being traversed provides for reduced losses of couplant during inspection operations.

[00138] In certain embodiments, the combination of the pivot points) and torsion spring act together to position the sled 1 perpendicular to the surface being traversed. The biasing force of the spring may act to extend the sled arms downward and away from the payload shaft and inspection sled mount, pushing the sled 1 toward the inspection surface. The torsion spring may be passive, applying a constant downward pressure, or the torsion spring or other biasing member may be active, allowing the downward pressure to be varied. In an illustrative and non- limiting example, an active torsion spring might be responsive to a command to relax the spring tension, reducing downward pressure and/or to actively pull the sled 1 up, when the sled 1 encounters an obstacle, allowing the sled 1 to more easily move over the obstacle. The active torsion spring may then be responsive to a command to restore tension, increasing downward pressure, once the obstacle is cleared to maintain the close contact between the sled 1 and the surface. The use of an active spring may enable changing the angle of a sensor or tool relative to the surface being traversed during a traverse. Design considerations with respect to the surfaces being inspected may be used to design the active control system. If the spring is designed to fail closed, the result would be similar to a passive spring and the sled 1 would be pushed toward the surface being inspected. If the spring is designed to fail open, the result would be increased obstacle clearance capabilities. In embodiments, spring may be a combination of passive and active biasing members.

[00139] The downward pressure applied by the torsion spring may be supplemented by a spring within the sled 1 further pushing a sensor or tool toward the surface. The downward pressure may be supplemented by one or more magnets in/on the sled 1 pulling the sled 1 toward the surface being traversed. The one or more magnets may be passive magnets that are constantly pulling the sled 1 toward the surface being traversed, facilitating a constant distance between the sled 1 and the surface. The one or magnets may be active magnets where the magnet field strength is controlled based on sensed orientation and/or distance of the sled 1 relative to the inspection surface. In an illustrative and non-limiting example, as the sled 1 lifts up from the surface to clear an obstacle and it starts to roll, the strength of the magnet may be increased to correct the orientation of the sled 1 and draw it back toward the surface.

[00140] The connection between each sled 1 and the sled arms 20 may constitute a simple pin or other quick release connect/disconnect attachment. The quick release connection at the pivot points may facilitate attaching and detaching sleds 1 enabling a user to easily change the type of inspection sled attached, swapping sensors, types of sensors, tools, and the like.

[00141] In embodiments, there may be multiple attachment or pivot point accommodations available on the sled 1 for connecting the sled arms. The location of the pivot point accommodations on the sled 1 may be selected to accommodate conflicting goals such as sled 1 stability and clearance of surface obstacles. Positioning the pivot point accommodations behind the center of sled in the longitudinal direction of travel may facilitate clearing obstacles on the surface being traversed. Positioning the pivot point accommodation forward of the center may make it more difficult for the sled 1 to invert or flip to a position where it cannot return to a proper inspection operation position. It may be desirable to alter the connection location of the sled arms to the pivot point accommodations (thereby defining the pivot point) depending on the direction of travel. The location of the pivot points on the sled 1 may be selected to accommodate conflicting goals such as sensor positioning relative to the surface and avoiding excessive wear on the bottom of the sled. In certain embodiments, where multiple pivot point accommodations are available, pivot point selection can occur before an inspection operation, and/or be selectable during an inspection operation (e.g., arms having an actuator to engage a selected one of the pivot points, such as extending pegs or other actuated elements, thereby selecting the pivot point).

[00142] In embodiments, the degree of rotation allowed by the pivot points may be adjustable. This may be done using mechanical means such as a physical pin, or lock. In embodiments, the connection between the sled 1 and the sled arms may include a spring that biases the pivot points to tend to pivot in one direction or another. The spring may be passive, with the selection of the spring based on the desired strength of the bias, and the installation of the spring may be such as to preferentially push the front or the back of the sled 1 down. In embodiments, the spring may be active, and the strength and preferential pivot may be varied based on direction of travel, presence of obstacles, desired pivoting responsiveness of the sled 1 to the presence of an obstacle or variation in the inspection surface, and the like. In certain embodiments, opposing springs or biasing members may be utilized to bias the sled 1 back to a selected position (e.g., neutral/flat on the surface, tilted forward, tilted rearward, etc.). Where the sled 1 is biased in a given direction (e.g., forward or rearward), the sled 1 may nevertheless operate in a neutral position during inspection operations, for example due to the down force from the arm on the sled 1.

[00143] An example sled 1, includes more than one pivot point, for example utilizing springs to couple to the sled arm. Pivot points provide additional clearance for the sled 1 to clear obstacles. In certain embodiments, both springs may be active, for example allowing some rotation of each pivot simultaneously, and/or a lifting of the entire sled. In certain embodiments, springs may be selectively locked - for example before inspection operations and/or actively controlled during inspection operations. Additionally or alternatively, selection of pivot position, spring force and/or ease of pivoting at each pivot may be selectively controlled - for example before inspection operations and/or actively controlled during inspection operations (e.g., using a controller 802). The utilization of springs is a non-limiting example of simultaneous multiple pivot points, and leaf springs, electromagnets, torsion springs, or other flexible pivot enabling structures are contemplated herein. The spring tension or pivot control may be selected based on the uniformity of the surface to be traversed. The spring tension may be varied between the front and rear pivot points depending on the direction of travel of the sled 1. In an illustrative and non-limiting example, the rear spring (relative to the direction of travel) might be locked and the front spring active when traveling forward to better enable obstacle accommodation. When direction of travel is reversed, the active and locked springs may be reversed such that what was the rear spring may now be active and what was the front spring may now be locked, again to accommodate obstacles encountered in the new direction of travel.

[00144] In embodiments, the bottom surface of the sled 1 may be shaped with one or more ramps to facilitate the sled 1 moving over obstacles encountered along the direction of travel. The shape and slope of each ramp may be designed to accommodate conflicting goals such as sled 1 stability, speed of travel, and the size of the obstacle the sled 1 is designed to accommodate. A steep ramp angle might be better for accommodating large obstacles but may be required to move more slowly to maintain stability and a good interaction with the surface. The slope of the ramp may be selected based on the surface to be traversed and expected obstacles. If the sled 1 is interacting with the surface in only one direction, the sled 1 may be designed with only one ramp. If the sled 1 is interacting with the surface going in two directions, the sled 1 may be designed with two ramps, e.g., a forward ramp and a rearward ramp, such that the sled 1 leads with a ramp in each direction of travel. The front and rear ramps may have different angles and/or different total height values. A ramp may have any shape, including a curved shape, a concave shape, a convex shape, and/or combinations thereof. The selection of the ramp angle, total ramp height, and bottom surface shape is readily determinable to one of skill in the art having the benefit of the disclosure herein and information ordinarily available when contemplating a system. Certain considerations for determining the ramp angle, ramp total height, and bottom surface shape include considerations of manufacturability, obstacle geometries likely to be encountered, obstacle materials likely to be encountered, materials utilized in the sled 1 and/or ramp, motive power available to the inspection robot 100, the desired response to encountering obstacles of a given size and shape (e.g., whether it is acceptable to stop operations and re-configure the inspection operations for a certain obstacle, or whether maximum obstacle traversal capability is desired), and/or likely impact speed with obstacles for a sled.

[00145] In embodiments, the bottom surface of the sled 1 may be contoured or curved to accommodate a known texture or shape of the surface being traversed, for example such that the sled 1 will tend to remain in a desired orientation (e.g., perpendicular) with the inspection surface as the sled 1 is moved. The bottom surface of the sled 1 may be shaped to reduce rotation, horizontal translation and shifting, and/or yaw or rotation of the sled 1 from side to side as it traverses the inspection surface. The bottom surface of the sled 1 may be convex for moving along a rounded surface, on the inside of a pipe or tube, and/or along a groove in a surface. The bottom surface of the sled 1 may be concave for the exterior of a rounded surface, such as riding on an outer wall of a pipe or tube, along a rounded surface, and/or along a ridge in a surface. The radius of curvature of the bottom surface of the sled 1 may be selected to facilitate alignment given the curvature of the surface to be inspected. The bottom surface of the sled 1 may be shaped to facilitate maintaining a constant distance between sensors or tools in the sled 1 and the inspection surface being traversed. In embodiments, at least a portion the bottom of the sled 1 may be flexible such that the bottom of the sled 1 may comply to the shape of the surface being traversed. This flexibility may facilitate traversing surfaces that change curvature over the length of the surface without the adjustments to the sled 1.

[00146] For a surface having a variable curvature, a chamfer or curve on the bottom surface of a sled 1 tends to guide the sled 1 to a portion of the variable curvature matching the curvature of the bottom surface. Accordingly, the curved bottom surface supports maintaining a selected orientation of the sled 1 to the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the bottom surface of the sled 1 is not curved, and one or more pivots combined with the down force support maintaining a selected orientation of the sled 1 to the inspection surface. In some embodiments, the bottom of the sled 1 may be flexible such that the curvature may adapt to the curvature of the surface being traversed. [00147] The material on the bottom of the sled 1 may be chosen to prevent wear on the sled 1, reduce friction between the sled 1 and the surface being traversed, or a combination of both. Materials for the bottom of the sled may include materials such as plastic, metal, or a combination thereof. Materials for the bottom of the sled may include an epoxy coat, a replaceable layer of polytetrafluoroethylene (e.g., Teflon), acetyl (e.g., - Delrin® acetyl resin), ultrafine molecular weight polyethylene (PMW), and the like. In embodiments, the material on the bottom of the sled 1 may be removable layer such as a sacrificial film (or layer, and/or removable layer) that is applied to the bottom of the sled 1 and then lifted off and replaced at selected intervals, before each inspection operation, and/or when the film or bottom of the sled begin to show signs of wear or an increase in friction.

[00148] In embodiments, an example sled 1 includes an upper portion and a replaceable lower portion having a bottom surface. In some embodiments, the lower portion may be designed to allow the bottom surface and shape to be changed to accommodate the specific surface to be traversed without having to disturb or change the upper portion. Accordingly, where sensors or tools engage the upper portion, the lower portion can be rapidly changed out to configure the sled 1 to the inspection surface, without disturbing sensor connections and/or coupling to the payload. The lower portion may additionally or alternatively be configured to accommodate a sacrificial layer. An example sled 1 includes a lower portion designed to be easily replaced by lining up the upper portion and the lower portion at a pivot point, and then rotating the pieces to align the two portions.

[00149] The ability to quickly swap the lower portion may facilitate changing the bottom surface of the sled 1 to improve or optimize the bottom surface of the sled 1 for the surface to be traversed. The lower portion may be selected based on bottom surface shape, ramp angle, or ramp total height value. The lower portion may be selected from a multiplicity of pre-configured replaceable lower portions in response to observed parameters of the inspection surface after arrival to an inspection site. Additionally or alternatively, the lower portion may include a simple composition, such as a wholly integrated part of a single material, and/or may be manufactured on-site (e.g., in a 3-D printing operation) such as for a replacement part and/or in response to observed parameters of the inspection surface after arrival to an inspection site. Improvement and/or optimization may include: providing a low friction material as the bottom surface to facilitate the sled 1 gliding over the surface being traversed, having a hardened bottom surface of the sled 1 if the surface to be traversed is abrasive, producing the lower portion as a wear material or low-cost replacement part, and the like. The replacement lower portion may allow for quick replacement of the bottom surface when there is wear or damage on the bottom surface of the sled 1. Additionally or alternatively, a user may alter a shape/curvature of the bottom of the sled, a slope or length of a ramp, the number of ramps, and the like. This may allow a user to swap out the lower portion of an individual sled 1 to change a sensor to a similar sensor having a different sensitivity or range, to change the type of sensor, manipulate a distance between the sensor and the inspection surface, replace a failed sensor, and the like. This may allow a user to swap out the lower portion of an individual sled 1 depending upon the surface curvature of the inspection surface, and/or to swap out the lower portion of an individual sled 1 to change between various sensors and/or tools.

[00150] Certain embodiments include an apparatus for providing acoustic coupling between a carriage (or sled) mounted sensor and an inspection surface. Example and non-limiting structures to provide acoustic coupling between a carriage mounted sensor and an inspection surface include an acoustic (e.g., an ultra-sonic) sensor mounted on a sled 1, the sled 1 mounted on a payload 2, and the pay load 2 coupled to an inspection robot. An example apparatus further includes providing the sled 1 with a number of degrees of freedom of motion, such that the sled 1 can maintain a selected orientation with the inspection surface - including a perpendicular orientation and/or a selected angle of orientation. Additionally or alternatively, the sled 1 is configured to track the surface, for example utilizing a shaped bottom of the sled 1 to match a shape of the inspection surface or a portion of the inspection surface, and/or the sled 1 having an orientation such that, when the bottom surface of the sled 1 is positioned against the inspection surface, the sensor maintains a selected angle with respect to the inspection surface.

[00151] Certain additional embodiments of an apparatus for providing acoustic coupling between a carriage mounted sensor and an inspection surface include utilization of a fixed-distance structure that ensures a consistent distance between the sensor and the inspection surface. For example, the sensor may be mounted on a cone, wherein an end of the cone touches the inspection surface and/or is maintained in a fixed position relative to the inspection surface, and the sensor mounted on the cone thereby is provided at a fixed distance from the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the sensor may be mounted on the cone, and the cone mounted on the sled 1, such that a change-out of the sled 1 can be performed to change out the sensor, without engaging or disengaging the sensor from the cone. In certain embodiments, the cone may be configured such that couplant provided to the cone results in a filled couplant chamber between a transducer of the sensor and the inspection surface. In certain additional embodiments, a couplant entry position for the cone is provided at a vertically upper position of the cone, between the cone tip portion and the sensor mounting end, in an orientation of the inspection robot as it is positioned on the surface, such that couplant flow through the cone tends to prevent bubble formation in the acoustic path between the sensor and the inspection surface. In certain further embodiments, the couplant flow to the cone is adjustable, and is capable, for example, to be increased in response to a determination that a bubble may have formed within the cone and/or within the acoustic path between the sensor and the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the sled 1 is capable of being lifted, for example with an actuator that lifts an arm 20, and/or that lifts a payload 2, such that a free fluid path for couplant and attendant bubbles to exit the cone and/or the acoustic path is provided. In certain embodiments, operations to eliminate bubbles in the cone and/or acoustic path are performed periodically, episodically (e.g., after a given inspection distance is completed, at the beginning of an inspection run, after an inspection robot pauses for any reason, etc.), and/or in response to an active determination that a bubble may be present in the cone and/or the acoustic path.

[00152] An example apparatus provides for low or reduced fluid loss of couplant during inspection operations. Example and non-limiting structures to provide for low or reduced fluid loss include providing for a limited flow path of couplant out of the inspection robot system - for example utilizing a cone having a smaller exit couplant cross-sectional area than a cross-sectional area of a couplant chamber within the cone. In certain embodiments, an apparatus for low or reduced fluid loss of couplant includes structures to provide for a selected down force on a sled 1 which the sensor is mounted on, on an arm carrying a sled 1 which the sensor is mounted on, and/or on a payload 2 which the sled 1 is mounted on. Additionally or alternatively, an apparatus providing for low or reduced fluid loss of couplant includes a selected down force on a cone providing for couplant connectivity between the sensor and the inspection surface - for example, a leaf spring or other biasing member within the sled 1 providing for a selected down force directly to the cone. In certain embodiments, low or reduced fluid loss includes providing for an overall fluid flow of between 0.12 to 0.16 gallons per minute to the inspection robot to support at least 10 ultra-sonic sensors. In certain embodiments, low or reduced fluid loss includes providing for an overall fluid flow of less than 50 feet per minute, less than 100 feet per minute, and less than 200 feet per minute fluid velocity in a tubing line feeding couplant to the inspection robot. In certain embodiments, low or reduced fluid loss includes providing sufficient couplant through a *4” tubing line to feed couplant to at least 6, at least 8, at least 10, at least 12, or at least 16 ultra-sonic sensors to a vertical height of at least 25 feet, at least 50 feet, at least 100 feet, at least 150 feet, or at least 200 feet. An example apparatus includes a *4” feed line to the inspection robot and/or to the payload 2, and a 1/8” feed line to individual sleds 1 and/or sensors (or acoustic cones associated with the sensors). In certain embodiments, larger and/or smaller diameter feed and individual fluid lines are provided.

[00153] An example system 100 includes an apparatus 800 (reference FIG. 5 and the disclosure referencing FIG. 5) for providing enhanced inspection information, including position-based information. The apparatus 800 and operations to provide the position-based information are described in the context of a particular physical arrangement of an industrial system for convenient illustration, however any physical arrangement of an industrial system is contemplated herein. Referencing FIG. 2, an example system includes a number of pipes 502 - for example vertically arranged pipes such as steam pipes in a power plant, pipes in a cooling tower, exhaust, or effluent gas pipes, or the like. The pipes 502 in FIG. 2 are arranged to create a tower having a circular crosssection for ease of description. In certain embodiments, periodic inspection of the pipes is utilized to ensure that pipe degradation is within limits, to ensure proper operation of the system, to determine maintenance and repair schedules, and/or to comply with policies or regulations. In the example of FIG. 2, an inspection surface 500 includes the inner portion of the tower, whereby an inspection robot 100 traverses the pipes 502 (e.g., vertically, inspecting one or more pipes on each vertical run). An example inspection robot 100 includes configurable payloads 2, and may include ultra-sonic sensors (e.g., to determine wall thickness and/or pipe integrity), magnetic sensors (e.g., to determine the presence and/or thickness of a coating on a pipe), cameras (e.g., to provide for visual inspection, including in EM ranges outside of the visual range, temperatures, etc.), composition sensors (e.g., gas chromatography in the area near the pipe, spectral sensing to detect leaks or anomalous operation, etc.), temperature sensing, pressure sensing (ambient and/or specific pressures), vibration sensing, density sensing, etc. The type of sensing performed by the inspection robot 100 is not limiting to the present disclosure except where specific features are described in relation to specific sensing challenges and opportunities for those sensed parameters as will be understood to one of skill in the art having the benefit of the disclosures herein.

[00154] In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 has alternatively or additionally, payload(s) 2 configured to provide for marking of aspects of the inspection surface 500 (e.g., a paint sprayer, an invisible or UV ink sprayer, and/or a virtual marking device configured to mark the inspection surface 500 in a memory location of a computing device but not physically), to repair a portion of the inspection surface 500 (e.g., apply a coating, provide a welding operation, apply a temperature treatment, install a patch, etc.), and/or to provide for a cleaning operation. Referencing FIG. 3, an example inspection robot 100 is depicted in position on the inspection surface 500 at a location. In the example, the inspection robot 100 traverses vertically and is positioned between two pipes 502, with payloads 2 configured to clean, sense, treat, and/or mark two adjacent pipes 502 in a single inspection run. The inspection robot 100 in the example includes two payloads 2 at the “front” (ahead of the robot housing in the movement direction) and two payloads 2 at the “rear” (behind the robot housing in the movement direction). The inspection robot 100 may include any arrangement of payloads 2, including just one or more payloads in front or behind, just one or more payloads off to either or both sides, and combinations of these. Additionally or alternatively, the inspection robot 100 may be positioned on a single pipe, and/or may traverse between positions during an inspection operation, for example to inspect selected areas of the inspection surface 500 and/or to traverse obstacles which may be present.

[00155] In certain embodiments, a “front” payload 2 includes sensors configured to determine properties of the inspection surface, and a “rear” payload 2 includes a responsive payload, such as an enhanced sensor, a cleaning device such as a sprayer, scrubber, and/or scraper, a marking device, and/or a repair device. The front-back arrangement of payloads 2 provides for adjustments, cleaning, repair, and/or marking of the inspection surface 500 in a single run - for example where an anomaly, gouge, weld line, area for repair, previously repaired area, past inspection area, etc., is sensed by the front payload 2, the anomaly can be marked, cleaned, repaired, etc. without requiring an additional run of the inspection robot 100 or a later visit by repair personnel. In another example, a first calibration of sensors for the front pay load may be determined to be incorrect (e.g., a front ultrasonic sensor calibrated for a particular coating thickness present on the pipes 502) and a rear sensor can include an adjusted calibration to account for the detected aspect (e.g., the rear sensor calibrated for the observed thickness of the coating). In another example, certain enhanced sensing operations may be expensive, time consuming, consume more resources (e.g., a gamma ray source, an alternate coupling such as a non-water or oil-based acoustic coupler, require a high energy usage, require greater processing resources, and/or incur usage charges to an inspection client for any reason) and the inspection robot 100 can thereby only utilize the enhanced sensing operations selectively and in response to observed conditions.

[00156] Referencing FIG. 4, a location 702 on the inspection surface 500 is identified for illustration. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 and/or apparatus 800 includes a controller 802 having a number of circuits structured to functionally execute operations of the controller 802. The controller 802 may be a single device (e.g., a computing device present on the robot 100, a computing device in communication with the robot 100 during operations and/or postprocessing information communicated after inspection operations, etc.) and/or a combination of devices, such as a portion of the controller 802 positioned on the robot 100, a portion of the controller 802 positioned on a computing device in communication with the robot 100, a portion of the controller 802 positioned on a handheld device (not shown) of an inspection operator, and/or a portion of the controller 802 positioned on a computing device networked with one or more of the preceding devices. Additionally or alternatively, aspects of the controller 802 may be included on one or more logic circuits, embedded controllers, hardware configured to perform certain aspects of the controller 802 operations, one or more sensors, actuators, network communication infrastructure (including wired connections, wireless connections, routers, switches, hubs, transmitters, and/or receivers), and/or a tether between the robot 100 and another computing device. The described aspects of the example controller 802 are non-limiting examples, and any configuration of the robot 100 and devices in communication with the robot 100 to perform all or selected ones of operations of the controller 802 are contemplated herein as aspects of an example controller 802.

[00157] In the example of FIG. 5, a position measurement may include a height determination combined with an azimuthal angle measurement and/or a pipe number value such that the inspection surface 500 location is defined thereby. Any coordinate system and/or position description system is contemplated herein. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 includes a robot positioning circuit 806, a processed data circuit 808 that combines the inspection data 812 with the position data 814 to determine position-based inspection data. The operations of the processed data circuit 808 may be performed at any time - for example during operations of the inspection robot 100 such that inspection data 812 is stored with position data 814, during a post-processing operation which may be completed separately from the inspection robot 100, and/or which may be performed after the inspection is completed, and/or which may be commenced while the inspection is being performed. In certain embodiments, the linking of the position data 814 with the inspection data 812 may be performed if the linked position-inspection data is requested - for example upon a request by a client for an inspection map 818. In certain embodiments, portions of the inspection data 812 are linked to the position data 814 at a first time, and other portions of the inspection data 812 are linked to the position data 814 at a later time and/or in response to post-processing operations, an inspection map 818 request, or other subsequent event.

[00158] The example controller 802 further includes an inspection visualization circuit 810 that determines the inspection map 818 in response to the inspection data 812 and the position data 814, for example using post-processed information from the processed data circuit 808. In a further example, the inspection visualization circuit 810 determines the inspection map 818 in response to an inspection visualization request 820, for example from a client computing device 826. In the example, the client computing device 826 may be communicatively coupled to the controller 802 over the internet, a network, through the operations of a web application, and the like. In certain embodiments, the client computing device 826 securely logs in to control access to the inspection map 818, and the inspection visualization circuit 810 may prevent access to the inspection map 818, and/or provide only portions of the inspection map 818, depending upon the successful login from the client computing device 826, the authorizations for a given user of the client computing device 826, and the like.

[00159] In certain embodiments, the inspection visualization circuit 810 and/or inspection data circuit 804 further accesses system data 816, such as a time of the inspection, a calendar date of the inspection, the robot 100 utilized during the inspection and/or the configurations of the robot 100, a software version utilized during the inspection, calibration and/or sensor processing options selected during the inspection, and/or any other data that may be of interest in characterizing the inspection, that may be requested by a client, that may be required by a policy and/or regulation, and/or that may be utilized for improvement to subsequent inspections on the same inspection surface 500 or another inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the processed data circuit 808 combines the system data 816 with the processed data for the inspection data 812 and/or the position data 814, and/or the inspection visualization circuit incorporates the system data 816 or portions thereof into the inspection map 818. In certain embodiments, any or all aspects of the inspection data 812, position data 814, and/or system data 816 may be stored as meta-data (e.g., not typically available for display), may be accessible in response to prompts, further selections, and/or requests from the client computing device 826, and/or may be utilized in certain operations with certain identifiable aspects removed (e.g., to remove personally identifiable information or confidential aspects) such as postprocessing to improve future inspection operations, reporting for marketing or other purposes, or the like.

[00160] In certain embodiments, the inspection visualization circuit 810 is further responsive to a user focus value 822 to update the inspection map 818 and/or to provide further information (e.g., focus data 824) to a user, such as a user of the client computing device 826. For example, a user focus value 822 (e.g., a user mouse position, menu selection, touch screen indication, keystroke, or other user input value indicating that a portion of the inspection map 818 has received the user focus) indicates that a location 702 of the inspection map 818 has the user focus, and the inspection visualization circuit 810 generates the focus data 824 in response to the user focus value 822, including potentially the location 702 indicated by the user focus value 822.

[00161] Referencing FIG. 6, an example inspection map 818 is depicted. In the example, the inspection surface 500 may be similar to that depicted in FIG. 2 - for example the interior surface of tower formed by a number of pipes to be inspected. The example inspection map 818 includes an azimuthal axis 902 and a height axis 904, with data from the inspection depicted on the inspection map 818 (e.g., at shading 906) indicating inspection data corresponding to that visual location).

Example and non- limiting inspection maps 818 include numeric values depicted on the visualization, colors, shading or hatching, and/or any other visual depiction method. In certain embodiments, more than one inspection dimension may be visualized (e.g., temperatures and wall thickness), and/or the inspection dimension may be selected or changed by the user. Additionally or alternatively, physical elements such as obstacles, build up on the inspection surface, weld lines, gouges, repaired sections, photos of the location (e.g., the inspection map 818 laid out over a panoramic photograph of the inspection surface 500 with data corresponding to the physical location depicted), may be depicted with or as a part of the inspection map 818. Additionally or alternatively, visual markers may be positioned on the inspection map 818 - for example, a red “X” (or any other symbol, including a color, bolded area, highlight, image data, a thumbnail, etc.) at a location of interest on the map - which marking may be physically present on the actual inspection surface 500 or only virtually depicted on the inspection map 818. It can be seen that the inspection map 818 provides for a convenient and powerful reference tool for a user to determine the results of the inspection operation and plan for future maintenance, repair, or inspections, as well as planning logistics in response to the number of aspects of the system requiring further work or analysis and the location of the aspects requiring further work or analysis. Accordingly, inspection results can be analyzed more quickly, regulatory or policy approvals and system up-time can be restored more quickly (if the system was shut-down for the inspection), configurations of an inspection robot 100 for a future inspection can be performed more quickly (e.g. preparing payload 2 configurations, obstacle management, and/or sensor selection or calibration), any of the foregoing can be performed with greater confidence that the results are reliable, and/or any combinations of the foregoing. Additionally or alternatively, less invasive operations can be performed, such as virtual marking which would not leave marks on the inspection surface 500 that might be removed (e.g., accidentally) before they are acted upon, which may remain after being acted upon, or which may create uncertainty as to when the marks were made over the course of multiple inspections and marking generations.

[00162] Referencing FIG. 7, an illustrative example inspection map 818 having focus data 824 is depicted. The example inspection map 818 is responsive to a user focus value 822, such as a mouse cursor 1002 hovering over a portion of the inspection map 818. In the example, the focus data 824 comes up as a tooltip, although any depiction operations such as output to a file, populating a static window for focus data 824, or any other operations known in the art are contemplated herein. The example focus data 824 includes a date (e.g., of the inspection), a time (e.g., of the inspection), the sensor calibrations utilized for the inspection, and the time to repair (e.g., down-time that would be required, actual repair time that would be required, the estimated time until the portion of the inspection surface 500 will require a repair, or any other description of a “time to repair”). The depicted focus data 824 is a non- limiting example, and any other information of interest may be utilized as focus data 824. In certain embodiments, a user may select the information, or portions thereof, utilized on the inspection map 818 - including at least the axes 902, 904 (e.g., units, type of information, relative versus absolute data, etc.) and the depicted data (e.g., units, values depicted, relative versus absolute values, thresholds or cutoffs of interest, processed values such as virtually determined parameters, and/or categorical values such as “PASSED” or “FAILED”). Additionally or alternatively, a user may select the information, or portions thereof, utilized as the focus data 824. [00163] In certain embodiments, an inspection map 818 (or display) provides an indication of how long a section of the inspection surface 500 is expected to continue under nominal operations, how much material should be added to a section of the inspection surface 500 (e.g., a repair coating or other material), and/or the type of repair that is needed (e.g., wall thickness correction, replacement of a coating, fixing a hole, breach, rupture, etc.).

[00164] Referencing FIG. 13, an apparatus 4100 for determining a facility wear value 4106 is depicted. The example apparatus 4100 includes a facility wear circuit 4102 that determines a facility wear model 4104 corresponding to the inspection surface 500 and/or an industrial facility, industrial system, and/or plant including the inspection surface 500. An example facility wear circuit 4102 accesses a facility wear model 4104, and utilizes the inspection data 812 to determine which portions of the inspection surface 500 will require repair, when they will require repair, what type of repair will be required, and a facility wear value 4106 including a description of how long the inspection surface 500 will last without repair, and/or with selected repairs. In certain embodiments, the facility wear model 4104 includes historical data for the particular facility, system, or plant having the inspection surface 500 - for example through empirical observation of previous inspection data 812, when repairs were performed, what types of repairs were performed, and/or how long repaired sections lasted after repairs.

[00165] Additionally or alternatively, the facility wear model 4104 includes data from offset facilities, systems, or plants (e.g., a similar system that operates a similar duty cycle of relevant temperatures, materials, process flow streams, vibration environment, etc. for the inspection surface 500; and which may include inspection data, repair data, and/or operational data from the offset system), canonical data (e.g., pre-entered data based on estimates, modeling, industry standards, or other indirect sources), data from other facilities from the same data client (e.g., an operator, original equipment manufacturer, owner, etc. for the inspection surface), and/or user-entered data (e.g., from an inspection operator and/or client of the data) such as assumptions to be utilized, rates of return for financial parameters, policies or regulatory values, and/or characterizations of experience in similar systems that may be understood based on the experience of the user. Accordingly, operations of the facility wear circuit 4102 can provide an overview of repair operations recommended for the inspection surface 500, including specific time frame estimates of when such repairs will be required, as well as a number of options for repair operations and how long they will last.

[00166] In certain embodiments, the facility wear value 4106, and/or facility wear value 4106 displayed on an inspection map 818, allows for strategic planning of repair operations, and/or coordinating the life cycle of the facility including the inspection surface 500 - for example performing a short-term repair at a given time, which might not be intuitively the “best” repair operation, but in view of a larger repair cycle that is upcoming for the facility. Additionally or alternatively, the facility wear value 4106 allows for a granular review of the inspection surface 500 - for example to understand operational conditions that drive high wear, degradation, and/or failure conditions of aspects of the inspection surface 500. In certain embodiments, repair data and/or the facility wear value 4106 are provided in a context distinct from an inspection map 818 - for example as part of an inspection report (not shown), as part of a financial output related to the system having the inspection surface (e.g., considering the costs and shutdown times implicated by repairs, and/or risks associated with foregoing a repair).

[00167] Referencing FIG. 14, a procedure 4200 for determining a facility wear value is depicted schematically. An example procedure 4200 includes an operation 4202 to interpret inspection data for an inspection surface, and an operation 4204 to access a facility wear model. The example procedure 4200 further includes an operation 4206 to determine a facility wear value in response to the inspection data and the facility wear model. The example procedure 4200 further includes an operation 4208 to provide the facility wear value - for example as a portion of an inspection map, an inspection report, and/or a financial report for a facility having the inspection surface. [00168] In embodiments, the robotic vehicle may incorporate a number of sensors distributed across a number of sensor sleds 1, such as with a single sensor mounted on a single sensor sled 1, a number of sensors mounted on a single sensor sled 1, a number of sensor sleds 1 arranged in a linear configuration perpendicular to the direction of motion (e.g., side-to-side across the robotic vehicle), arranged in a linear configuration along the direction of motion (e.g., multiple sensors on a sensor sled 1 or multiple sensor sleds 1 arranged to cover the same surface location one after the other as the robotic vehicle travels). Additionally or alternatively, a number of sensors may be arranged in a two-dimensional surface area, such as by providing sensor coverage in a distributed manner horizontally and/or vertically (e.g., in the direction of travel), including offset sensor positions. In certain embodiments, the utilization of payloads 2 with sensor sleds mounted thereon enables rapid configuration of sensor placement as desired, sleds 1 on a given payload 2 can be further adjusted, and/or sensor(s) on a given sled can be changed or configured as desired.

[00169] In certain embodiments, two payloads 2 side-by-side allow for a wide horizontal coverage of sensing for a given travel of the inspection robot 100 - for example as depicted in FIG. 1. In certain embodiments, a payload 2 is coupled to the inspection robot 100 with a pin or other quickdisconnect arrangement, allowing for the payload 2 to be removed, to be reconfigured separately from the inspection robot 100, and/or to be replaced with another payload 2 configured in a desired manner. The payload 2 may additionally have a couplant connection to the inspection robot 100 and/or an electrical connection to the inspection robot 100. Each sled may include a couplant connection conduit where the couplant connection conduit is coupled to a payload couplant connection at the upstream end and is coupled to the couplant entry of the cone at the downstream end. Multiple payload couplant connections on a single payload may be coupled together to form a single couplant connection between the payload and the inspection robot. The single couplant connection per pay load facilitates the changing of the payload without having to connect/disconnect the couplant line connections at each sled. The couplant connection conduit between the payload couplant connection and the couplant entry of the cone facilitates connecting/disconnecting a sled from a payload without having to connect/disconnect the couplant connection conduit from the couplant entry of the cone. The couplant and/or electrical connections may include power for the sensors as required, and/or communication coupling (e.g., a datalink or network connection).

Additionally or alternatively, sensors may communicate wirelessly to the inspection robot 100 or to another computing device, and/or sensors may store data in a memory associated with the sensor, sled 1, or payload 2, which may be downloaded at a later time. Any other connection type required for a payload 2, such as compressed air, paint, cleaning solutions, repair spray solutions, or the like, may similarly be coupled from the payload 2 to the inspection robot 100. [00170] The horizontal configuration of sleds 1 (and sensors) is selectable to achieve the desired inspection coverage. For example, sleds 1 may be positioned to provide a sled running on each of a selected number of pipes of an inspection surface, positioned such that several sleds 1 combine on a single pipe of an inspection surface (e.g., providing greater radial inspection resolution for the pipe), and/or at selected horizontal distances from each other (e.g., to provide 1 inch resolution, 2 inch resolution, 3 inch resolution, etc.). In certain embodiments, the degrees of freedom of the sensor sleds 1 allow for distributed sleds 1 to maintain contact and orientation with complex surfaces. [00171] In certain embodiments, sleds 1 are articulable to a desired horizontal position. For example, quick disconnects may be provided (pins, claims, set screws, etc.) that allow for the sliding of a sled 1 to any desired location on a payload 2, allowing for any desired horizontal positioning of the sleds 1 on the payload 2. Additionally or alternatively, sleds 1 may be movable horizontally during inspection operations. For example, a worm gear or other actuator may be coupled to the sled 1 and operable (e.g., by a controller 802) to position the sled 1 at a desired horizontal location. In certain embodiments, only certain ones of the sleds 1 are moveable during inspection operations - for example outer sleds 1 for maneuvering past obstacles. In certain embodiments, all of the sleds 1 are moveable during inspection operations - for example to support arbitrary inspection resolution (e.g., horizontal resolution, and/or vertical resolution), to configure the inspection trajectory of the inspection surface, or for any other reason. In certain embodiments, the pay load 2 is horizontally moveable before or during inspection operations. In certain embodiments, an operator configures the pay load 2 and/or sled 1 horizontal positions before inspection operations (e.g., before or between inspection runs). In certain embodiments, an operator, or a controller 802 configures the payload 2 and/or sled 1 horizontal positions during inspection operations. In certain embodiments, an operator can configure the payload 2 and/or sled 1 horizontal positions remotely, for example communicating through a tether or wirelessly to the inspection robot.

[00172] In certain embodiments, the robotic vehicle includes sensor sleds with one sensor and sensor sleds with a plurality of sensors. A number of sensors arranged on a single sensor sled may be arranged with the same sensor type across the direction of robotic vehicle travel (e.g., perpendicular to the direction of travel, or “horizontal”) to increase coverage of that sensor type (e.g., to cover different surfaces of an object, such as two sides of a pipe), arranged with the same sensor type along the direction of robotic vehicle travel (e.g., parallel to the direction of travel, or “vertical”) to provide redundant coverage of that sensor type over the same location (e.g., to ensure data coverage, to enable statistical analysis based on multiple measurements over the same location), arranged with a different sensor type across the direction of robotic vehicle travel to capture a diversity of sensor data in side-by-side locations along the direction of robotic vehicle travel (e.g., providing both ultra-sonic and conductivity measurements at side-by-side locations), arranged with a different sensor type along the direction of robotic vehicle travel to provide predictive sensing from a leading sensor to a trailing sensor (e.g., running a trailing gamma-ray sensor measurement only if a leading ultra-sonic sensor measurement indicates the need to do so), combinations of any of these, and the like. The modularity of the robotic vehicle may permit exchanging sensor sleds with the same sensor configuration (e.g., replacement due to wear or failure), different sensor configurations (e.g., adapting the sensor arrangement for different surface applications), and the like.

[00173] Providing for multiple simultaneous sensor measurements over a surface area, whether for taking data from the same sensor type or from different sensor types, provides the ability to maximize the collection of sensor data in a single run of the robotic vehicle. If the surface over which the robotic vehicle was moving were perfectly flat, the sensor sled could cover a substantial surface with an array of sensors. However, the surface over which the robotic vehicle travels may be highly irregular, and have obstacles over which the sensor sleds must adjust, and so the preferred embodiment for the sensor sled is relatively small with a highly flexible orientation, as described herein, where a plurality of sensor sleds is arranged to cover an area along the direction of robotic vehicle travel. Sensors may be distributed amongst the sensor sleds as described for individual sensor sleds (e.g., single sensor per sensor sled, multiple sensors per sensor sled (arranged as described herein)), where total coverage is achieved through a plurality of sensor sleds mounted to the robotic vehicle. One such embodiment, as introduced herein, such as depicted in FIG. 1, comprises a plurality of sensor sleds arranged linearly across the direction of robotic vehicle travel, where the plurality of sensor sleds is capable of individually adjusting to the irregular surface as the robotic vehicle travels. Further, each sensor sled may be positioned to accommodate regular characteristics in the surface (e.g., positioning sensor sleds to ride along a selected portion of a pipe aligned along the direction of travel), to provide for multiple detections of a pipe or tube from a number of radial positions, sensor sleds may be shaped to accommodate the shape of regular characteristics in the surface (e.g., rounded surface of a pipe), and the like. In this way, the sensor sled arrangement may accommodate both the regular characteristics in the surface (e.g., a series of features along the direction of travel) and irregular characteristics along the surface (e.g., obstacles that the sensor sleds flexibly mitigate during travel along the surface).

[00174] Although FIG. 1 depicts a linear arrangement of sensor sleds with the same extension (e.g., the same connector arm length), another example arrangement may include sensor sleds with different extensions, such as where some sensor sleds are arranged to be positioned further out, mounted on longer connection arms. This arrangement may have the advantage of allowing a greater density of sensors across the configuration, such as where a more leading sensor sled could be positioned linearly along the configuration between two more trailing sensor sleds such that sensors are provided greater linear coverage than would be possible with all the sensor sleds positioned side- by-side. This configuration may also allow improved mechanical accommodation between the springs and connectors that may be associated with connections of sensor sleds to the arms and connection assembly (e.g., allowing greater individual movement of sensor sleds without the sensor sleds making physical contact with one another).

[00175] Embodiments with multiple sensor sled connector assemblies provide configurations and area distribution of sensors that may enable greater flexibility in sensor data taking and processing, including alignment of same-type sensor sleds allowing for repeated measurements (e.g., the same sensor used in a leading sensor sled as in a trailing sensor sled, such as for redundancy or verification in data taking when leading and trailing sleds are co-aligned), alignment of different-type sensor sleds for multiple different sensor measurements of the same path (e.g., increase the number of sensor types taking data, have the lead sensor provide data to the processor to determine whether to activate the trailing sensor (e.g., ultra-sonic I gamma-ray, and the like)), off-set alignment of sametype sensor sleds for increased coverage when leading and trailing sleds are off-set from one another with respect to travel path, off-set alignment of different-type sensor sleds for trailing sensor sleds to measure surfaces that have not been disturbed by leading sensor sleds (e.g., when the leading sensor sled is using a couplant), and the like.

[00176] The modular design of the robotic vehicle may provide for a system flexible to different applications and surfaces (e.g., customizing the robot and modules of the robot ahead of time based on the application, and/or during an inspection operation), and to changing operational conditions (e.g., flexibility to changes in surface configurations and conditions, replacement for failures, reconfiguration based on sensed conditions), such as being able to change out sensors, sleds, assemblies of sleds, number of sled arrays, and the like.

[00177] Throughout the present description, certain orientation parameters are described as “horizontal,” “perpendicular,” and/or “across” the direction of travel of the inspection robot, and/or described as “vertical,” “parallel,” and/or in line with the direction of travel of the inspection robot. It is specifically contemplated herein that the inspection robot may be travelling vertically, horizontally, at oblique angles, and/or on curves relative to a ground-based absolute coordinate system. Accordingly, except where the context otherwise requires, any reference to the direction of travel of the inspection robot is understood to include any orientation of the robot - such as an inspection robot traveling horizontally on a floor may have a “vertical” direction for purposes of understanding sled distribution that is in a “horizontal” absolute direction. Additionally, the “vertical” direction of the inspection robot may be a function of time during inspection operations and/or position on an inspection surface - for example as an inspection robot traverses over a curved surface. In certain embodiments, where gravitational considerations or other context-based aspects may indicate - vertical indicates an absolute coordinate system vertical - for example in certain embodiments where couplant flow into a cone is utilized to manage bubble formation in the cone. In certain embodiments, a trajectory through the inspection surface of a given sled may be referenced as a “horizontal inspection lane” - for example, the track that the sled takes traversing through the inspection surface.

[00178] Certain embodiments include an apparatus for acoustic inspection of an inspection surface with arbitrary resolution. Arbitrary resolution, as utilized herein, includes resolution of features in geometric space with a selected resolution - for example resolution of features (e.g., cracks, wall thickness, anomalies, etc.) at a selected spacing in horizontal space (e.g., perpendicular to a travel direction of an inspection robot) and/or vertical space (e.g., in a travel direction of an inspection robot). While resolution is described in terms of the travel motion of an inspection robot, resolution may instead be considered in any coordinate system, such as cylindrical or spherical coordinates, and/or along axes unrelated to the motion of an inspection robot. It will be understood that the configurations of an inspection robot and operations described in the present disclosure can support arbitrary resolution in any coordinate system, with the inspection robot providing sufficient resolution as operated, in view of the target coordinate system. Accordingly, for example, where inspection resolution of 6-inches is desired in a target coordinate system that is diagonal to the travel direction of the inspection robot, the inspection robot and related operations described throughout the present disclosure can support whatever resolution is required (whether greater than 6-inches, less than 6-inches, or variable resolution depending upon the location over the inspection surface) to facilitate the 6-inch resolution of the target coordinate system. It can be seen that an inspection robot and/or related operations capable of achieving an arbitrary resolution in the coordinates of the movement of the inspection robot can likewise achieve arbitrary resolution in any coordinate system for the mapping of the inspection surface. For clarity of description, apparatus, and operations to support an arbitrary resolution are described in view of the coordinate system of the movement of an inspection robot.

[00179] An example apparatus to support acoustic inspection of an inspection surface includes an inspection robot having a payload and a number of sleds mounted thereon, with the sleds each having at least one acoustic sensor mounted thereon. Accordingly, the inspection robot is capable of simultaneously determining acoustic parameters at a range of positions horizontally. Sleds may be positioned horizontally at a selected spacing, including providing a number of sleds to provide sensors positioned radially around several positions on a pipe or other surface feature of the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, vertical resolution is supported according to the sampling rate of the sensors, and/or the movement speed of the inspection robot. Additionally or alternatively, the inspection robot may have vertically displaced payloads, having an additional number of sleds mounted thereon, with the sleds each having at least one acoustic sensor mounted thereon. The utilization of additional vertically displaced payloads can provide additional resolution, either in the horizontal direction (e.g., where sleds of the vertically displaced payload(s) are offset from sleds in the first payload(s)) and/or in the vertical direction (e.g., where sensors on sleds of the vertically displaced payload(s) are sampling such that sensed parameters are vertically offset from sensors on sleds of the first payload(s)). Accordingly, it can be seen that, even where physical limitations of sled spacing, numbers of sensors supported by a given payload, or other considerations limit horizontal resolution for a given payload, horizontal resolution can be enhanced through the utilization of additional vertically displaced payloads. In certain embodiments, an inspection robot can perform another inspection run over a same area of the inspection surface, for example with sleds tracking in an offset line from a first run, with positioning information to ensure that both horizontal and/or vertical sensed parameters are offset from the first run.

[00180] Accordingly, an apparatus is provided that achieves significant resolution improvements, horizontally and/or vertically, over previously known systems. Additionally or alternatively, an inspection robot performs inspection operations at distinct locations on a descent operation than on an ascent operation, providing for additional resolution improvements without increasing a number of run operations required to perform the inspection (e.g., where an inspection robot ascends an inspection surface, and descends the inspection surface as a normal part of completing the inspection run). In certain embodiments, an apparatus is configured to perform multiple run operations to achieve the selected resolution. It can be seen that the greater the number of inspection runs required to achieve a given spatial resolution, the longer the down time for the system (e.g., an industrial system) being inspected (where a shutdown of the system is required to perform the inspection), the longer the operating time and greater the cost of the inspection, and/or the greater chance that a failure occurs during the inspection. Accordingly, even where multiple inspection runs are required, a reduction in the number of the inspection runs is beneficial.

[00181] In certain embodiments, an inspection robot includes a low fluid loss couplant system, enhancing the number of sensors that are supportable in a given inspection run, thereby enhancing available sensing resolution. In certain embodiments, an inspection robot includes individual down force support for sleds and/or sensors, providing for reduced fluid loss, reduced off-nominal sensing operations, and/or increasing the available number of sensors supportable on a payload, thereby enhancing available sensing resolution. In certain embodiments, an inspection robot includes a single couplant connection for a payload, and/or a single couplant connection for the inspection robot, thereby enhancing reliability and providing for a greater number of sensors on a payload and/or on the inspection robot that are available for inspections under commercially reasonable operations (e.g., configurable for inspection operations with reasonable reliability, checking for leaks, expected to operate without problems over the course of inspection operations, and/or do not require a high level of skill or expensive test equipment to ensure proper operation). In certain embodiments, an inspection robot includes acoustic sensors coupled to acoustic cones, enhancing robust detection operations (e.g., a high percentage of valid sensing data, ease of acoustic coupling of a sensor to an inspection surface, etc.), reducing couplant fluid losses, and/or easing integration of sensors with sleds, thereby supporting an increased number of sensors per payload and/or inspection robot, and enhancing available sensing resolution. In certain embodiments, an inspection robot includes utilizing water as a couplant, thereby reducing fluid pumping losses, reducing risks due to minor leaks within a multiple plumbing line system to support multiple sensors, and/or reducing the impact (environmental, hazard, clean-up, etc.) of performing multiple inspection runs and/or performing an inspection operation with a multiplicity of acoustic sensors operating.

[00182] Referencing FIG. 8, an example apparatus 3400 is depicted for configuring a trailing sensor inspection scheme in response to a leading sensor inspection value. The example apparatus 3400 includes a controller 802 having an inspection data circuit 804 that interprets lead inspection data 3402 from a lead sensor. Example and non-limiting lead sensors include a sensor mounted on a sled of a forward payload, a sensor mounted on either a forward payload or a rear payload of an inspection robot having a trailing payload, and/or a sensor operated on a first run of an inspection robot, where operations of the apparatus 3400 proceed with adjusting operations of a sensor on a subsequent run of the inspection robot (e.g., the first run is ascending, and the subsequent run is descending; the first run is descending, and the subsequent run is ascending; and/or the first run is performed at a first time, and the subsequent run is performed at a second, later, time).

[00183] The example controller 802 further includes a sensor configuration circuit 3404 structured to determine a configuration adjustment 3406 for a trailing sensor. Example and non-limiting trailing sensors include any sensor operating over the same or a substantially similar portion of the inspection surface as the lead sensor, at a later point in time. A trailing sensor may be a sensor positioned on a payload behind the payload having the lead sensor, a physically distinct sensor from the lead sensor operating over the same or a substantially similar portion of the inspection surface after the lead sensor, and/or a sensor that is physically the same sensor as the lead sensor, but reconfigured in some aspect (e.g., sampling parameters, calibrations, inspection robot rate of travel change, etc.). A portion that is substantially similar includes a sensor operating on a sled in the same horizontal track (e.g., in the direction of inspection robot movement) as the lead sensor, a sensor that is sensing a portion of the inspection sensor that is expected to determine the same parameters (e.g., wall thickness in a given area) of the inspection surface as that sensed by the lead sensor, and/or a sensor operating in a space of the inspection area where it is expected that determinations for the lead sensor would be effective in adjusting the trailing sensor. Example and non-limiting determinations for the lead sensor to be effective in adjusting the trailing sensor include pipe thickness determinations for a same pipe and/or same cooling tower, where pipe thickness expectations may affect the calibrations or other settings utilized by the lead and trailing sensors; determination of a coating thickness where the trailing sensor operates in an environment that has experienced similar conditions (e.g., temperatures, flow rates, operating times, etc.) as the conditions experienced by the environment sensed by the lead sensor; and/or any other sensed parameter affecting the calibrations or other settings utilized by the lead and trailing sensors where knowledge gained by the lead sensor could be expected to provide information utilizable for the trailing sensor. [00184] Example and non-limiting configuration adjustments 3406 include changing of sensing parameters such as cut-off times to observe peak values for ultra-sonic processing, adjustments of rationality values for ultra-sonic processing, enabling of trailing sensors or additional trailing sensors (e.g., X-ray, gamma ray, high resolution camera operations, etc.), adjustment of a sensor sampling rate (e.g., faster or slower), adjustment of fault cut-off values (e.g., increase or decrease fault cutoff values), adjustment of any transducer configurable properties (e.g., voltage, waveform, gain, filtering operations, and/or return detection algorithm), and/or adjustment of a sensor range or resolution value (e.g., increase a range in response to a lead sensing value being saturated or near a range limit, decrease a range in response to a lead sensing value being within a specified range window, and/or increase or decrease a resolution of the trailing sensor). In certain embodiments, a configuration adjustment 3406 to adjust a sampling rate of a trailing sensor includes by changing a movement speed of an inspection robot. Example and non-limiting configuration adjustments include any parameters described in relation to FIGS. 15-17 and the related descriptions. It can be seen that the knowledge gained from the lead inspection data 3402 can be utilized to adjust the trailing sensor plan which can result more reliable data (e.g., where calibration assumptions appear to be off-nominal for the real inspection surface), the saving of one or more inspection runs (e.g., reconfiguring the sensing plan in real-time to complete a successful sensing run during inspection operations), improved operations for a subsequent portion of a sensing run (e.g., a first inspection run of the inspection surface improves the remaining inspection runs, even if the vertical track of the first inspection run must be repeated), and/or efficient utilization of expensive sensing operations by utilizing such operations only when the lead inspection data 3402 indicates such operations are useful or required. The example controller 802 includes a sensor operation circuit 3408 that adjusts parameters of the trailing sensor in response to the configuration adjustment 3406, and the inspection data circuit 804 interpreting trailing inspection data 3410, wherein the trailing sensors are responsive to the adjusted parameters by the sensor operation circuit.

[00185] Referencing FIG. 9, an example procedure 3500 to configure a trailing sensor in response to a leading sensor value is depicted. The example procedure 3500 includes an operation 3502 to interpret lead inspection data provided by a leading sensor, and an operation 3504 to determine whether the lead inspection data indicates that a trailing sensor configuration should be adjusted. Where the operation 3504 determines that the trailing sensor configuration should be adjusted, the example procedure 3500 includes an operation 3506 to adjust the trailing sensor configuration in response to the lead inspection data. Example and non-limiting operations 3506 to adjust a trailing sensor configuration include changing a calibration for the sensor (e.g., an analog/digital processor configuration, cutoff time values, and/or speed-of-sound values for one or more materials), changing a range or resolution of the trailing sensor, enabling or disabling sensing operations of a trailing sensor, and/or adjusting a speed of travel of an inspection robot. In certain embodiments, operations 3506 include adjusting a horizontal position of a trailing sensor (e.g., where a horizontal position of a sled 1 on a payload 2 is actively controllable by a controller 802, and/or adjusted manually between the lead sensing operation and the trailing sensing operation).

[00186] In certain embodiments, lead inspection data 3402 includes ultra-sonic information such as processed ultra-sonic information from a sensor, and the sensor configuration circuit 3404 determines to utilize a consumable, slower, and/or more expensive sensing, repair, and/or marking operation by providing a configuration adjustment 3406 instructing a trailing sensor to operate, or to change nominal operations, in response to the lead inspection data 3402. For example, lead inspection data 3402 may indicate a thin wall, and sensor configuration circuit 3404 provides the configuration adjustment 3406 to alter a trailing operation such as additional sensing with a more capable sensor (e.g., a more expensive or capable ultra-sonic sensor, an X-ray sensor, a gamma ray sensor, or the like) and/or to operate a repair or marking tool (e.g., which may have a limited or consumable amount of coating material, marking material, or the like) at the location determined to have the thin wall. Accordingly, expense, time, and/or operational complication can be added to inspection operations in a controlled manner according to the lead inspection data 3402.

[00187] An example apparatus is disclosed to perform an inspection of an industrial surface. Many industrial surfaces are provided in hazardous locations, including without limitation where heavy or dangerous mechanical equipment operates, in the presence of high temperature environments, in the presence of vertical hazards, in the presence of corrosive chemicals, in the presence of high pressure vessels or lines, in the presence of high voltage electrical conduits, equipment connected to and/or positioned in the vicinity of an electrical power connection, in the presence of high noise, in the presence of confined spaces, and/or with any other personnel risk feature present. Accordingly, inspection operations often include a shutdown of related equipment, and/or specific procedures to mitigate fall hazards, confined space operations, lockout-tagout procedures, or the like. In certain embodiments, the utilization of an inspection robot allows for an inspection without a shutdown of the related equipment. In certain embodiments, the utilization of an inspection robot allows for a shutdown with a reduced number of related procedures that would be required if personnel were to perform the inspection. In certain embodiments, the utilization of an inspection robot provides for a partial shutdown to mitigate some factors that may affect the inspection operations and/or put the inspection robot at risk, but allows for other operations to continue. For example, it may be acceptable to position the inspection robot in the presence of high pressure or high voltage components, but operations that generate high temperatures may be shut down.

[00188] In certain embodiments, the utilization of an inspection robot provides additional capabilities for operation. For example, an inspection robot having positional sensing within an industrial environment can request shutdown of only certain aspects of the industrial system that are related to the current position of the inspection robot, allowing for partial operations as the inspection is performed. In another example, the inspection robot may have sensing capability, such as temperature sensing, where the inspection robot can opportunistically inspect aspects of the industrial system that are available for inspection, while avoiding other aspects or coming back to inspect those aspects when operational conditions allow for the inspection. Additionally, in certain embodiments, it is acceptable to risk the industrial robot (e.g., where shutting down operations exceed the cost of the loss of the industrial robot) to perform an inspection that has a likelihood of success, where such risks would not be acceptable for personnel. In certain embodiments, a partial shutdown of a system has lower cost than a full shutdown, and/or can allow the system to be kept in a condition where restart time, startup operations, etc. are at a lower cost or reduced time relative to a full shutdown. In certain embodiments, the enhanced cost, time, and risk of performing additional operations beyond mere shutdown, such as compliance with procedures that would be required if personnel were to perform the inspection, can be significant.

[00189] Referencing FIG. 10, an example apparatus 3600 to inspect a plant, industrial system, and/or inspection surface utilizing position information is depicted schematically. The example apparatus 3600 includes a position definition circuit 3602 that interprets position information 3604, and/or determines a plant position definition 3606 (e.g., a plant definition value) and an inspection robot position (e.g., as one or more plant position values 3614) in response to the position information 3604. Example and non-limiting position information 3604 includes relative and/or absolute position information - for example, a distance from a reference position (e.g., a starting point, stopping point, known object in proximity to the plant, industrial system, and/or inspection surface, or the like). In certain embodiments, position information 3604 is determinable according to a global positioning service (GPS) device, ultra- wide band radio frequency (RF) signaling, LIDAR or other direct distance measurement devices (including line-of-sight and/or sonar devices), aggregating from reference points (e.g., routers, transmitters, know devices in communication with the inspection robot, or the like), utilizing known obstacles as a reference point, encoders (e.g., a wheel counter or other device), barometric sensors (e.g., altitude determination), utilization of a known sensed value correlated to position (e.g., sound volume or frequency, temperature, vibration, etc.), and/or utilizing an inertial measurement unit (e.g., measuring and/or calculating utilizing an accelerometer and/or gyroscope). In certain embodiments, values may be combined to determine the position information 3604 - for example in 3-D space without further information, four distance measurements are ordinarily required to determine a specific position value. However, utilizing other information, such as a region of the inspection surface that the inspection robot is operating on (e.g., which pipe the inspection robot is climbing), an overlay of the industrial surface over the measurement space, a distance traveled from a reference point, a distance to a reference point, etc., the number of distance measurements required to determine a position value can be reduced to three, two, one, or even eliminated and still position information 3604 is determinable. In certain embodiments, the position definition circuit 3602 determines the position information 3604 completely or partially on dead reckoning (e.g., accumulating speed and direction from a known position, and/or direction combined with a distance counter), and/or corrects the position information 3604 when feedback based position data (e.g., a true detected position) is available.

[00190] Example and non-limiting plant position values 3608 include the robot position information 3604 integrated within a definition of the plant space, such as the inspection surface, a defined map of a portion of the plant or industrial system, and/or the plant position definition 3606. In certain embodiments, the plant space is predetermined, for example as a map interpreted by the controller 802 and/or pre-loaded in a data file describing the space of the plant, inspection surface, and/or a portion of the plant or industrial surface. In certain embodiments, the plant position definition 3606 is created in real-time by the position definition circuit 3602 - for example by integrating the position information 3604 traversed by the inspection robot, and/or by creating a virtual space that includes the position information 3604 traversed by the inspection robot. For example, the position definition circuit 3602 may map out the position information 3604 over time, and create the plant position definition 3606 as the aggregate of the position information 3604, and/or create a virtual surface encompassing the aggregated plant position values 3614 onto the surface. In certain embodiments, the position definition circuit 3602 accepts a plant shape value 3608 as an input (e.g., a cylindrical tank being inspected by the inspection robot having known dimensions), deduces the plant shape value 3608 from the aggregated position information 3604 (e.g., selecting from one of a number of simple or available shapes that are consistent with the aggregated plant position definition 3606), and/or prompts a user (e.g., an inspection operator and/or a client for the data) to select one of a number of available shapes to determine the plant position definition 3606.

[00191] The example apparatus 3600 includes a data positioning circuit 3610 that interprets inspection data 3612 and correlates the inspection data 3612 to the position information 3604 and/or to the plant position values 3614. Example and non-limiting inspection data 3612 includes: sensed data by an inspection robot; environmental parameters such as ambient temperature, pressure, time- of-day, availability and/or strength of wireless communications, humidity, etc.; image data, sound data, and/or video data taken during inspection operations; metadata such as an inspection number, customer number, operator name, etc.; setup parameters such as the spacing and positioning of sleds, payloads, mounting configuration of sensors, and the like; calibration values for sensors and sensor processing; and/or operational parameters such as fluid flow rates, voltages, pivot positions for the payload and/or sleds, inspection robot speed values, downforce parameters, etc. In certain embodiments, the data positioning circuit 3610 determines the positional information 3604 corresponding to inspection data 3612 values, and includes the positional information 3604 as an additional parameter with the inspection data 3612 values and/or stores a correspondence table or other data structure to relate the positional information 3604 to the inspection data 3612 values. In certain embodiments, the data positioning circuit 3610 additionally or alternatively determines the plant position definition 3606, and includes a plant position value 3614 (e.g., as a position within the plant as defined by the plant position definition 3606) as an additional parameter with the inspection data 3612 values and/or stores a correspondence table or other data structure to relate the plant position values 3614 to the inspection data 3612 values. In certain embodiments, the data positioning circuit 3610 creates position informed data 3616, including one or more, or all, aspects of the inspection data 3612 correlated to the position information 3604 and/or to the plant position values 3614.

[00192] In certain embodiments, for example where dead reckoning operations are utilized to provide position information 3604 over a period of time, and then a corrected position is available through a feedback position measurement, the data positioning circuit 3602 updates the position informed inspection data 3616 - for example re-scaling the data according to the estimated position for values according to the changed feedback position (e.g., where the feedback position measurement indicates the inspection robot traveled 25% further than expected by dead reckoning, position information 3604 during the dead reckoning period can be extended by 25%) and/or according to rationalization determinations or externally available data (e.g., where over 60 seconds the inspection robot traverses 16% less distance than expected, but sensor readings or other information indicate the inspection robot may have been stuck for 10 seconds, then the position information 3604 may be corrected to represent the 10-seconds of non-motion rather than a full rescale of the position informed inspection data 3616). In certain embodiments, dead reckoning operations may be corrected based on feedback measurements as available, and/or in response to the feedback measurement indicating that the dead reckoning position information exceeds a threshold error value (e.g., 1%, 0.1%, 0.01%, etc.).

[00193] It can be seen that the operations of apparatus 3600 provide for position-based inspection information. Certain systems, apparatuses, and procedures throughout the present disclosure utilize and/or can benefit from position informed inspection data 3616, and all such embodiments are contemplated herein. Without limitation to any other disclosures herein, certain aspects of the present disclosure include: providing a visualization of inspection data 3612 in position information 3604 space and/or in plant position value 3614 space; utilizing the position informed inspection data 3616 in planning for a future inspection on the same or a similar plant, industrial system, and/or inspection surface (e.g., configuring sled number and spacing, inspection robot speed, inspection robot downforce for sleds and/or sensors, sensor calibrations, planning for traversal and/or avoidance of obstacles, etc.); providing a format for storing a virtual mark (e.g., replacing a paint or other mark with a virtual mark as a parameter in the inspection data 3612 correlated to a position); determining a change in a plant condition in response to the position informed inspection data 3616 (e.g., providing an indication that expected position information 3604 did not occur in accordance with the plant position definition 3606 - for example indicating a failure, degradation, or unexpected object in a portion of the inspected plant that is not readily visible); and/or providing a health indicator of the inspection surface (e.g., depicting regions that are nominal, passed, need repair, will need repair, and/or have failed). In certain embodiments, it can be seen that constructing the position informed inspection data 3616 using position information 3604 only, including dead reckoning based position information 3604, nevertheless yields many of the benefits of providing the position informed inspection data 3616. In certain further embodiments, the position informed inspection data 3616 is additionally or alternatively constructed utilizing the plant position definition 3606, and/or the plant position values 3614.

[00194] Referencing FIG. 11, an example procedure 3700 to inspect a plant, industrial system, and/or inspection surface utilizing position information is depicted. The example procedure 3700 includes an operation 3702 to interpret position information, an operation 3704 to interpret inspection data, and an operation 3706 to correlate the inspection data to the position information. The example procedure 3700 further includes an operation 3708 to correct the position information (e.g., updating a dead reckoning-based position information), and to update the correlation of the inspection data to the position information. The example procedure further includes an operation 3710 to provide position informed inspection data in response to the correlated inspection data. In certain embodiments, operation 3706 is additionally or alternatively performed on the position informed inspection data, where the position informed inspection data is corrected, and operation 3710 includes providing the position informed inspection data. In certain embodiments, one or more operations of a procedure 3700 are performed by a controller 802.

[00195] Referencing FIG. 12, an example procedure 3800 to inspect a plant, industrial system, and/or inspection surface utilizing position information is depicted. In addition to operations of procedure 3700, example procedure 3800 includes an operation 3802 to determine a plant definition value, and an operation 3804 to determine plant position values in response to the position information and the plant position definition. Operation 3706 further includes an operation to correlate the inspection data with the position information and/or the plant position values. In certain embodiments, one or more operations of procedure 3800 are performed by a controller 802.

[00196] Referencing FIG. 15, an example procedure 4600 to adjust an inspection operation in realtime in response to a magnetic induction sensor is schematically depicted. In certain embodiments, example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4602 to determine an induction processing parameter, such as a substrate distance value, a sensor position value, and/or a rationality diagnostic value. In certain embodiments, the example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4604 to adjust an inspection plan in response to the induction processing parameter. Example and non-limiting operations 4604 to an inspection plan include: adjusting a sensor calibration value (e.g., for an ultra-sonic sensor, a temperature sensor, etc.) for a sensor that may be affected by the coating, debris, or other matter between the magnetic induction sensor and a substrate of the inspection surface; adjusting an inspection resolution for one or more sensors for a planned inspection operation; adjusting a planned inspection map display for an inspection operation, and/or including adjusting sensors, sled positions, and/or an inspection robot trajectory to support the planned inspection map display; adjusting an inspection robot trajectory (e.g., locations, paths, number of runs, and/or movement speed on the inspection surface); adjusting a number, type, and/or positioning (e.g., sled numbers, placement, and/or payload positions) for sensors for an inspection operation; adjusting a wheel magnet strength and/or wheel configuration of an inspection robot in response to the induction processing parameter (e.g., adjusting for an expected distance to a ferrous material, configuring the wheels to manage debris, etc.); adjusting a sled ramp configuration (e.g., sled ramp leading and/or following slope, shape, and/or depth); and/or adjusting a down force for a sled and/or sensor. Operations 4604 may be performed in real-time, such as a change of an inspection plan during inspection operations, and/or at design or set-up time, such as a change of a configuration for the inspection robot or any other aspects described herein before an inspection run, between inspection runs, or the like.

[00197] In certain embodiments, the example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4606 to perform an additional inspection operation in response to the induction processing parameter. For example, operation 4606 may include operations such as: inspecting additional portions of the inspection surface and/or increasing the size of the inspection surface (e.g., to inspect other portions of an industrial system, facility, and/or inspection area encompassing the inspection surface); to activate trailing payloads and/or a rear payload to perform the additional inspection operation; rerunning an inspection operation over an inspection area that at least partially overlaps a previously inspected area; and/or performing a virtual additional inspection operation - for example reprocessing one or more aspects of inspection data in view of the induction processing parameter. [00198] In certain embodiments, the example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4608 to follow a detected feature, for example activating a sensor configured to detect the feature as the inspection robot traverses the inspection surface, and/or configuring the inspection robot to adjust a trajectory to follow the feature (e.g., by changing the robot trajectory in real-time, and/or performing additional inspection operations to cover the area of the feature). Example and non-limiting features include welds, grooves, cracks, coating difference areas (e.g., thicker coating, thinner coating, and/or a presence or lack of a coating). In certain embodiments, the example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4610 to perform at least one of a marking, repair, and/or treatment operation, for example marking features (e.g., welds, grooves, cracks, and/or coating difference areas), and/or performing a repair and/or treatment operation (e.g., welding, applying an epoxy, applying a cleaning operation, and/or applying a coating) appropriate for a feature. In certain embodiments, operation 4610 to perform a marking operation includes marking the inspection surface in virtual space - for example as a parameter visible on an inspection map but not physically applied to the inspection surface.

[00199] In certain embodiments, the example procedure 4600 includes an operation 4612 to perform a re-processing operation in response to the induction processing parameter. For example, and without limitation, acoustic raw data, primary mode values and/or primary mode score values, and/or secondary mode values and/or secondary mode score values may be recalculated over at least a portion of an inspection area in response to the induction processing parameter. In certain embodiments, ultra-sonic sensor calibrations may be adjusted in a post-processing operation to evaluate, for example, wall thickness and/or imperfections (e.g., cracks, deformations, grooves, etc.) utilizing the induction processing parameter(s).

[00200] Operations for procedure 4600 are described in view of an induction processing parameter for clarity of description. It is understood that a plurality of induction processing parameters, including multiple parameter types (e.g., coating presence and/or coating thickness) as well as a multiplicity of parameter determinations (e.g., position-based induction processed values across at least a portion of the inspection surface) are likewise contemplated herein. In certain embodiments, one or more operations of procedure 4600 are performed by a controller 802.

[00201] Referencing FIG. 16, an example apparatus 4700 for utilizing a profiling sensor on an inspection robot is schematically depicted. Example and non-limiting profiling sensors include a laser profiler (e.g., a high spatial resolution laser beam profiler) and/or a high-resolution caliper log. A profiling sensor provides for a spatial description of the inspection surface - for example variations in a pipe 502 or other surface can be detected, and/or a high-resolution contour of at least a portion of the inspection surface can be determined. In certain embodiments, a controller 802 includes a profiler data circuit 4702 that interprets profiler data 4704 provided by the profiling sensor. The example controller 802 further includes an inspection surface characterization circuit 4706 that provides a characterization of the shape of the inspection surface in response to the profiler data - for example as a shape description 4708 of the inspection surface, including anomalies, variations in the inspection surface geometry, and/or angles of the inspection surface (e.g., to determine a perpendicular angle to the inspection surface). The example controller 802 further includes a profile adjustment circuit 4710 that provides an inspection operation adjustment 4712 in response to the shape description 4708. Example and non-limiting inspection operation adjustments 4712 include: providing an adjustment to a sled, payload, and/or sensor orientation within a sled (e.g., to provide for a more true orientation due to a surface anomaly, including at least changing a number and configuration of sleds on a payload, configuring a payload to avoid an obstacle, adjusting a down force of a sled, arm, sensor, and/or payload, and/or adjusting a shape of a sled bottom surface); a change to a sensor resolution value (e.g., to gather additional data in the vicinity of an anomaly or shape difference of the inspection surface); a post-processing operation (e.g., recalculating ultra-sonic and/or magnetic induction data - for example in response to a shape of the inspection surface, and/or in response to a real orientation of a sensor to the inspection surface - such as correcting for oblique angles and subsequent sonic and/or magnetic effects); a marking operation (e.g., marking an anomaly, shape difference, and/or detected obstacle in real space - such as on the inspection surface - and/or in virtual space such as on an inspection map); and/or providing the inspection operation adjustment 4712 as an instruction to a camera to capture an image of an anomaly and/or a shape difference.

[00202] Referencing FIG. 17, an example procedure 4800 for utilizing a profiling sensor on an inspection robot is schematically depicted. The example procedure 4800 includes an operation 4802 to operate a profiling sensor on at least a portion of an inspection surface, and an operation 4804 to interpret profiler data in response to the operation 4802. The example procedure 4800 further includes an operation 4806 to characterize a shape of the inspection surface, and/or thereby provide a shape description for the inspection surface, and an operation 4808 to adjust an inspection operation in response to the shape of the inspection surface.

[00203] As shown in Fig 18, a system may comprise a base station 4902 connected by a tether 4904 to a center module 4910 of a robot 4908 used to traverse an industrial surface. The tether 4904 may be a conduit for power, fluids, control, and data communications between the base station 4902 and the robot 4908. The robot 4908 may include a center module 4910 connected to one or more drive modules 4912 which enable the robot 4908 to move along an industrial surface. The center module 4910 may be coupled to one or more sensor modules 4914 for measuring an industrial surface - for example, the sensor modules 4914 may be positioned on a drive module 4912, on the payload, in the center body housing, and/or aspects of a sensor module 4914 may be distributed among these. An example embodiment includes the sensor modules 4914 each positioned on an associated drive module 4912, and electrically coupled to the center module 4910 for power, communications, and/or control. The base station 4902 may include an auxiliary pump 4920, a control module 4924 and a power module 4922. The example robot 4908 may be an inspection robot, which may include any one or more of the following features: inspection sensors, cleaning tools, and/or repair tools. In certain embodiments, it will be understood that an inspection robot 4908 is configured to perform only cleaning and/or repair operations, and/or may be configured for sensing, inspection, cleaning, and/or repair operations at different operating times (e.g., performing one type of operation at a first operating time, and performing another type of operation at a second operating time), and/or may be configured to perform more than one of these operations in a single run or traversal of an industrial surface (e.g., the “inspection surface”). The modules 4910, 4912, 4914, 4920, 4922, 4924 are configured to functionally execute operations described throughout the present disclosure, and may include any one or more hardware aspects as described herein, such as sensors, actuators, circuits, drive wheels, motors, housings, payload configurations, and the like.

[00204] Referring to FIG. 19, the power module 4922 may receive AC electrical power as an input (e.g., from standard power outlets, available power at an industrial site, etc.), the input power may range, without limitation, from 85 Volts to 240 Volts and 10 Amps to 20 Amps. The power module 4922 may include transformers (e.g., two transformers 5002 5004). An example low power AC-DC transformer 5002 transforms the input power to a low output power 5010 of 24 Volts DC. An example high-power AC-DC transformer 5004 transforms the input power to a high output power 5012 of approximately 365 Volts DC. The use of the high output power 5012 as input to the robot 4908 provides a high-power density to the robot, and enables a reduction in the weight of the tether 4904 relative to that required if the low output power 5010 were used to power the robot 4908, as well as providing for a higher robot climbing capability (e.g., using a longer tether), lower coupling forces on the tether, and/or providing extra capacity within a given tether weight profile for additional coupled aspects (e.g., communications, couplant flow capability, tether hardening or shielding capability, etc.). The low output power 5010 may be used to power peripherals 5014 on the base station 4902 such as an operator interface, a display, and the like. The low output power 5010 may also be used to power a robot proximity circuit 5018 and/or a HV protection and monitoring module 5020. An example system includes the control module 4924 of the base station using the low output power 5010 on the tether 4904 to verify the presence of the robot 4908 at the end of the tether 4904 using the robot proximity circuit 5018. The HV protection and monitoring module 5020 verifies the integrity of the tether by checking for overcurrent, shorts, and voltage differences before coupling the high output power 5012. An example tether may include a proximity line having a specific resistor value. A safe, known low voltage may be supplied to the proximity line, the voltage at the top of the robot measured and the voltage drop compared with the expected voltage drop across the tether given the known resistance. Once the integrity of the tether 4904 and the presence of the robot 4908 are verified, the power through the tether 4904 is switched to the high output power 5012. The HV protection and monitoring module 5020 may include fuses of any type, which may be e-fuses allowing for re-coupling of protected circuits after a fuse is activated. The fuses protect the robot proximity circuit 5018 and the robot 4908 by shutting off power if an overcurrent or short condition is detected. The use of the e-fuses enables the fuse to be reset with a command rather than having to physically replace the fuse.

[00205] The control module 4924 may be in communication with the robot 4908 by way of the tether 4904. Additionally or alternatively, the control module 4924 may communicate with the robot 4908 wirelessly, through a network, or in any other manner. The robot 4908 may provide the base station 4902 with any available information, such as, without limitation: the status of the robot 4908 and associated components, data collected by the sensor module 4914 regarding the industrial surface, vertical height of the robot 4908, water pressure and/or flow rate coming into the robot 4908, visual data regarding the robot’s environment, position information for the robot 4908 and/or information (e.g., encoder traversal distances) from which the control module 4924 can determine the position of the robot. The control module 4924 may provide the robot 4908 with commands such as navigational commands, commands to the sensor modules regarding control of the sensor modules and the like, warning of an upcoming power loss, couplant pressure information, and the like.

[00206] The base station 4902 may receive an input of couplant, typically water, from an external source such as a plant or municipal water source. The base station 4902 may include a pressure and/or flow sensing device to measure incoming flow rate and/or pressure. Typically, the incoming couplant may be supplied directly to the tether 4904 for transport to the robot 4908. However, if the incoming pressure is low or the flow rate is insufficient, the couplant may be run through the auxiliary pump 4920 prior to supplying the couplant to the tether 4904. In certain embodiments, the base station 4902 may include a make-up tank and/or a couplant source tank, for example to supply couplant if an external source is unavailable or is insufficient for an extended period. The auxiliary pump 4920 may be regulated by the control module 4924 based on data from the sensor and/or combined with data received from the robot 4908. The auxiliary pump 4920 may be used to: adjust the pressure of the couplant sent to the robot 4908 based on the vertical height of the robot 4908; adjust for spikes or drops in the incoming couplant; provide intermittent pressure increases to flush out bubbles in the acoustic path of ultra-sonic sensors, and the like. The auxiliary pump 4920 may include a shut off safety valve in case the pressure exceeds a threshold.

[00207] As shown in FIG. 20, the center module 4910 (or center body) of the robot may include a couplant inlet 5102, a data communications/control tether input 5112, forward facing and reverse facing navigation cameras 5104, multiple sensor connectors 5118, couplant outlets 5108 (e.g., to each payload), and one or more drive module connections 5110 (e.g., one on each side). An example center module 4910 includes a distributed controller design, with low-level and hardware control decision making pushed down to various low level control modules (e.g., 5114, and/or further control modules on the drive modules as described throughout the present disclosure). The utilization of a distributed controller design, for example as depicted schematically in FIG. 25, facilitates rapid design, rapid upgrades to components, and compatibility with a range of components and associated control modules 5114. For example, the distributed controller design allows the high level controller (e.g., the brain/gateway) to provide communications in a standardized high-level format (e.g., requesting movement rates, sensed parameter values, powering of components, etc.) without utilizing the hardware specific low-level controls and interfaces for each component, allowing independent development of hardware components and associated controls. The use of the low-level control modules may improve development time and enable the base level control module to be component neutral and send commands, leaving the specific implementation up to the low-level control module 5114 associated with a specific camera, sensor, sensor module, actuator, drive module, and the like. The distributed controller design may extend to distributing the local control to the drive module(s) and sensor module(s) as well.

[00208] Referring to FIGS. 21-22, the bottom surface of the center module 4910 may include a cold plate 5202 to disperse heat built up by electronics in the center module 4910. Couplant transferred from the base station 4902 using the tether 4904 may be received at the couplant inlet 5102 where it then flows through a manifold 5302 where the couplant may transfer excess heat away from the central module 4910. The manifold 5302 may also split the water into multiple streams for output through two or more couplant outlets 5108. The utilization of the cold plate 5202 and heat transfer to couplant passing through the center body as a part of operations of the inspection robot provides for greater capability and reliability of the inspection robot by providing for improved heat rejection for heat generating components (e.g., power electronics and circuits), while adding minimal weight to the robot and tether. FIG. 22 depicts an example distribution of couplant flow through the cold plate and to each payload. In certain embodiments, couplant flow may also be provided to a rear payload, which may have a direct flow passage and/or may further include an additional cold plate on a rear portion of the inspection robot.

[00209] The robot may have information regarding absolute and relative position. The drive module may include both contact and non-contact encoders to provide estimates of the distance travelled. In certain embodiments, absolute position may be provided through integration of various determinations, such as the ambient pressure and/or temperature in the region of the inspection robot, communications with positional elements (e.g., triangulation and/or GPS determination with routers or other available navigation elements), coordinated evaluation of the driven wheel encoders (which may slip) with a non-slip encoder assembly, and/or by any other operations described throughout the present disclosure. In certain embodiments, an absolute position may be absolute in one sense (e.g., distance traversed from a beginning location or home position) but relative in another sense (e.g., relative to that beginning location).

[00210] The base station may include a GPS module or other facility for recognizing the position of the base station in a plant. The encoders on the drive module provide both absolute (relative to the robot) and relative information regarding movement of the robot over time. The combination of data regarding an absolute position of the base station and the relative movement of the robot may be used to ensure complete plant inspection and the ability to correlate location with inspection map. [00211] Referring to FIGS. 23 and 24A-C, an example of a rail 7000 is seen with a plurality of sensor carriages 7004 attached and an inspection camera 7002 attached. As shown in FIG. 24A, the inspection camera 7002 may be aimed downward (e.g., at 38 degrees) such that it captures an image of the inspection surface that can be coordinated with sensor measurements. The inspection video captured may be synchronized with the sensor data and/or with the video captured by the navigation cameras on the center module. The inspection camera 7002 may have a wide field of view such that the image captured spans the width of the payload and the surface measured by all of the sensor carriages 7004 on the rail 7000.

[00212] The length of the rail may be designed to according to the width of sensor coverage to be provided in a single pass of the inspection robot, the size and number of sensor carriages, the total weight limit of the inspection robot, the communication capability of the inspection robot with the base station (or other communicated device), the deliverability of couplant to the inspection robot, the physical constraints (weight, deflection, etc.) of the rail and/or the clamping block, and/or any other relevant criteria. A rail may include one or more sensor carriage clamps 7200 having joints with several degrees of freedom for movement to allow the robot to continue even if one or more sensor carriages encounter unsurmountable obstacles (e.g., the entire payload can be raised, the sensor carriage can articulate vertically and raise over the obstacle, and/or the sensor carriage can rotate and traverse around the obstacle).

[00213] The rail actuator connector 7006 may be connected to a rail which is able to provide a configurable down-force on the attached sensor carriages 7004 to assure contact and/or desired engagement angle with the inspection surface. The rail actuator 7006 may facilitate engaging and disengaging the rail 7000 (and associated sensor carriages 7004) from the inspection surface to facilitate obstacle avoidance, angle transitions, engagement angle, and the like. Rail actuators may operate independently of one another. Thus, rail engagement angle may vary between drive modules on either side of the center module, between front and back rails on the same drive module, and the like.

[00214] An example procedure for detecting and/or traversing obstacles is described following. An example procedure includes evaluating at least one of: a wheel slippage determination value, a motor torque value, and a visual inspection value (e.g., through the camera, by an operator or controller detecting an obstacle directly and/or verifying motion). The example procedure further includes determining that an obstacle is present in response to the determinations. In certain embodiments, one or more determinations are utilized to determine that an obstacle may be present (e.g., a rapid and/or low-cost determination, such as the wheel slippage determination value and/or the motor torque value), and another determination is utilized to confirm the obstacle is present and/or to confirm the location of the obstacle (e.g., the visual inspection value and/or the wheel slippage determination value, which may be utilized to identify the specific obstacle and/or confirm which side of the inspection robot has the obstacle). In certain embodiments, one or more obstacle avoidance maneuvers may be performed, which may be scheduled in an order of cost, risk, and/or likelihood of success, including such operations as: raising the payload, facilitating a movement of the sensor carriage around the obstacle, reducing and/or manipulating a down force of the payload and/or of a sensor carriage, moving the inspection robot around and/or to avoid the obstacle, and/or changing the inspection run trajectory of the inspection robot.

[00215] FIG. 85 depicts a schematic block diagram of a control scheme for an inspection robot. The example control scheme includes distributed control, with a high-level controller (e.g., the brain/gateway, and/or with distributed elements in the base station) providing standardized commands and communications to highly capable low-level controllers that provide hardware specific responses. Various communication and/or power paths are depicted between controllers in the example of FIG. 25, although specific communication protocols, electrical power characteristics, and the like are non- limiting examples for clarity of the present description. In the example of FIG. 25, two separate drive modules may be present in certain embodiments, each having an interface to the center body. In the example of FIG. 25, the sensor module includes the inspection cameras and sensor communications, and may be on the payload and/or associated with the payload (e.g., on the center body side and in communication with sensors of the payload).

[00216] The methods and systems described herein may be deployed in part or in whole through a machine having a computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server that executes computer readable instructions, program codes, instructions, and/or includes hardware configured to functionally execute one or more operations of the methods and systems disclosed herein. The terms computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server, as utilized herein, should be understood broadly.

[00217] Any one or more of the terms computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server include a computer of any type, capable to access instructions stored in communication thereto such as upon a non-transient computer readable medium, whereupon the computer performs operations of systems or methods described herein upon executing the instructions. In certain embodiments, such instructions themselves comprise a computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server. Additionally or alternatively, a computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server may be a separate hardware device, one or more computing resources distributed across hardware devices, and/or may include such aspects as logical circuits, embedded circuits, sensors, actuators, input and/or output devices, network and/or communication resources, memory resources of any type, processing resources of any type, and/or hardware devices configured to be responsive to determined conditions to functionally execute one or more operations of systems and methods herein. [00218] Network and/or communication resources include, without limitation, local area network, wide area network, wireless, internet, or any other known communication resources and protocols. Example and non-limiting hardware, computers, computing devices, processors, circuits, and/or servers include, without limitation, a general purpose computer, a server, an embedded computer, a mobile device, a virtual machine, and/or an emulated version of one or more of these. Example and non-limiting hardware, computers, computing devices, processors, circuits, and/or servers may be physical, logical, or virtual. A computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server may be: a distributed resource included as an aspect of several devices; and/or included as an interoperable set of resources to perform described functions of the computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server, such that the distributed resources function together to perform the operations of the computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server. In certain embodiments, each computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server may be on separate hardware, and/or one or more hardware devices may include aspects of more than one computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server, for example as separately executable instructions stored on the hardware device, and/or as logically partitioned aspects of a set of executable instructions, with some aspects of the hardware device comprising a part of a first computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server, and some aspects of the hardware device comprising a part of a second computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server.

[00219] A computer, computing device, processor, circuit, and/or server may be part of a server, client, network infrastructure, mobile computing platform, stationary computing platform, or other computing platform. A processor may be any kind of computational or processing device capable of executing program instructions, codes, binary instructions and the like. The processor may be or include a signal processor, digital processor, embedded processor, microprocessor, or any variant such as a co-processor (math co-processor, graphic co-processor, communication co-processor and the like) and the like that may directly or indirectly facilitate execution of program code or program instructions stored thereon. In addition, the processor may enable execution of multiple programs, threads, and codes. The threads may be executed simultaneously to enhance the performance of the processor and to facilitate simultaneous operations of the application. By way of implementation, methods, program codes, program instructions and the like described herein may be implemented in one or more threads. The thread may spawn other threads that may have assigned priorities associated with them; the processor may execute these threads based on priority or any other order based on instructions provided in the program code. The processor may include memory that stores methods, codes, instructions, and programs as described herein and elsewhere. The processor may access a storage medium through an interface that may store methods, codes, and instructions as described herein and elsewhere. The storage medium associated with the processor for storing methods, programs, codes, program instructions or other type of instructions capable of being executed by the computing or processing device may include but may not be limited to one or more of a CD-ROM, DVD, memory, hard disk, flash drive, RAM, ROM, cache, and the like.

[00220] A processor may include one or more cores that may enhance speed and performance of a multiprocessor. In embodiments, the process may be a dual core processor, quad core processors, other chip- level multiprocessor and the like that combine two or more independent cores (called a die).

[00221] The methods and systems described herein may be deployed in part or in whole through a machine that executes computer readable instructions on a server, client, firewall, gateway, hub, router, or other such computer and/or networking hardware. The computer readable instructions may be associated with a server that may include a file server, print server, domain server, internet server, intranet server and other variants such as secondary server, host server, distributed server, and the like. The server may include one or more of memories, processors, computer readable transitory and/or non-transitory media, storage media, ports (physical and virtual), communication devices, and interfaces capable of accessing other servers, clients, machines, and devices through a wired or a wireless medium, and the like. The methods, programs, or codes as described herein and elsewhere may be executed by the server. In addition, other devices required for execution of methods as described in this application may be considered as a part of the infrastructure associated with the server.

[00222] The server may provide an interface to other devices including, without limitation, clients, other servers, printers, database servers, print servers, file servers, communication servers, distributed servers, and the like. Additionally, this coupling and/or connection may facilitate remote execution of instructions across the network. The networking of some or all of these devices may facilitate parallel processing of program code, instructions, and/or programs at one or more locations without deviating from the scope of the disclosure. In addition, all the devices attached to the server through an interface may include at least one storage medium capable of storing methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs. A central repository may provide program instructions to be executed on different devices. In this implementation, the remote repository may act as a storage medium for methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs.

[00223] The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs may be associated with a client that may include a file client, print client, domain client, internet client, intranet client and other variants such as secondary client, host client, distributed client, and the like. The client may include one or more of memories, processors, computer readable transitory and/or non-transitory media, storage media, ports (physical and virtual), communication devices, and interfaces capable of accessing other clients, servers, machines, and devices through a wired or a wireless medium, and the like. The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs as described herein and elsewhere may be executed by the client. In addition, other devices utilized for execution of methods as described in this application may be considered as a part of the infrastructure associated with the client.

[00224] The client may provide an interface to other devices including, without limitation, servers, other clients, printers, database servers, print servers, file servers, communication servers, distributed servers, and the like. Additionally, this coupling and/or connection may facilitate remote execution of methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs across the network. The networking of some or all of these devices may facilitate parallel processing of methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs at one or more locations without deviating from the scope of the disclosure. In addition, all the devices attached to the client through an interface may include at least one storage medium capable of storing methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs. A central repository may provide program instructions to be executed on different devices. In this implementation, the remote repository may act as a storage medium for methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs.

[00225] The methods and systems described herein may be deployed in part or in whole through network infrastructures. The network infrastructure may include elements such as computing devices, servers, routers, hubs, firewalls, clients, personal computers, communication devices, routing devices and other active and passive devices, modules, and/or components as known in the art. The computing and/or non-computing device(s) associated with the network infrastructure may include, apart from other components, a storage medium such as flash memory, buffer, stack, RAM, ROM, and the like. The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs described herein and elsewhere may be executed by one or more of the network infrastructural elements.

[00226] The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs described herein and elsewhere may be implemented on a cellular network having multiple cells. The cellular network may either be frequency division multiple access (FDMA) network or code division multiple access (CDMA) network. The cellular network may include mobile devices, cell sites, base stations, repeaters, antennas, towers, and the like.

[00227] The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs described herein and elsewhere may be implemented on or through mobile devices. The mobile devices may include navigation devices, cell phones, mobile phones, mobile personal digital assistants, laptops, palmtops, netbooks, pagers, electronic books readers, music players, and the like. These mobile devices may include, apart from other components, a storage medium such as a flash memory, buffer, RAM, ROM and one or more computing devices. The computing devices associated with mobile devices may be enabled to execute methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs stored thereon. Alternatively, the mobile devices may be configured to execute instructions in collaboration with other devices. The mobile devices may communicate with base stations interfaced with servers and configured to execute methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs. The mobile devices may communicate on a peer-to-peer network, mesh network, or other communications network. The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs may be stored on the storage medium associated with the server and executed by a computing device embedded within the server. The base station may include a computing device and a storage medium. The storage device may store methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs executed by the computing devices associated with the base station.

[00228] The methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs may be stored and/or accessed on machine readable transitory and/or non- transitory media that may include: computer components, devices, and recording media that retain digital data used for computing for some interval of time; semiconductor storage known as random access memory (RAM); mass storage typically for more permanent storage, such as optical discs, forms of magnetic storage like hard disks, tapes, drums, cards and other types; processor registers, cache memory, volatile memory, non-volatile memory; optical storage such as CD, DVD; removable media such as flash memory (e.g., USB sticks or keys), floppy disks, magnetic tape, paper tape, punch cards, standalone RAM disks, Zip drives, removable mass storage, off-line, and the like; other computer memory such as dynamic memory, static memory, read/write storage, mutable storage, read only, random access, sequential access, location addressable, file addressable, content addressable, network attached storage, storage area network, bar codes, magnetic ink, and the like.

[00229] Certain operations described herein include interpreting, receiving, and/or determining one or more values, parameters, inputs, data, or other information. Operations including interpreting, receiving, and/or determining any value parameter, input, data, and/or other information include, without limitation: receiving data via a user input; receiving data over a network of any type; reading a data value from a memory location in communication with the receiving device; utilizing a default value as a received data value; estimating, calculating, or deriving a data value based on other information available to the receiving device; and/or updating any of these in response to a later received data value. In certain embodiments, a data value may be received by a first operation, and later updated by a second operation, as part of the receiving a data value. For example, when communications are down, intermittent, or interrupted, a first operation to interpret, receive, and/or determine a data value may be performed, and when communications are restored an updated operation to interpret, receive, and/or determine the data value may be performed.

[00230] Certain logical groupings of operations herein, for example methods or procedures of the current disclosure, are provided to illustrate aspects of the present disclosure. Operations described herein are schematically described and/or depicted, and operations may be combined, divided, reordered, added, or removed in a manner consistent with the disclosure herein. It is understood that the context of an operational description may require an ordering for one or more operations, and/or an order for one or more operations may be explicitly disclosed, but the order of operations should be understood broadly, where any equivalent grouping of operations to provide an equivalent outcome of operations is specifically contemplated herein. For example, if a value is used in one operational step, the determining of the value may be required before that operational step in certain contexts (e.g. where the time delay of data for an operation to achieve a certain effect is important), but may not be required before that operation step in other contexts (e.g. where usage of the value from a previous execution cycle of the operations would be sufficient for those purposes). Accordingly, in certain embodiments an order of operations and grouping of operations as described is explicitly contemplated herein, and in certain embodiments re-ordering, subdivision, and/or different grouping of operations is explicitly contemplated herein.

[00231] The methods and systems described herein may transform physical and/or intangible items from one state to another. The methods and systems described herein may also transform data representing physical and/or intangible items from one state to another.

[00232] The elements described and depicted herein, including in flow charts, block diagrams, and/or operational descriptions, depict and/or describe specific example arrangements of elements for purposes of illustration. However, the depicted and/or described elements, the functions thereof, and/or arrangements of these, may be implemented on machines, such as through computer executable transitory and/or non-transitory media having a processor capable of executing program instructions stored thereon, and/or as logical circuits or hardware arrangements. Example arrangements of programming instructions include at least: monolithic structure of instructions; standalone modules of instructions for elements or portions thereof; and/or as modules of instructions that employ external routines, code, services, and so forth; and/or any combination of these, and all such implementations are contemplated to be within the scope of embodiments of the present disclosure Examples of such machines include, without limitation, personal digital assistants, laptops, personal computers, mobile phones, other handheld computing devices, medical equipment, wired or wireless communication devices, transducers, chips, calculators, satellites, tablet PCs, electronic books, gadgets, electronic devices, devices having artificial intelligence, computing devices, networking equipment, servers, routers and the like. Furthermore, the elements described and/or depicted herein, and/or any other logical components, may be implemented on a machine capable of executing program instructions. Thus, while the foregoing flow charts, block diagrams, and/or operational descriptions set forth functional aspects of the disclosed systems, any arrangement of program instructions implementing these functional aspects are contemplated herein. Similarly, it will be appreciated that the various steps identified and described above may be varied, and that the order of steps may be adapted to particular applications of the techniques disclosed herein. Additionally, any steps or operations may be divided and/or combined in any manner providing similar functionality to the described operations. All such variations and modifications are contemplated in the present disclosure. The methods and/or processes described above, and steps thereof, may be implemented in hardware, program code, instructions, and/or programs or any combination of hardware and methods, program code, instructions, and/or programs suitable for a particular application. Example hardware includes a dedicated computing device or specific computing device, a particular aspect or component of a specific computing device, and/or an arrangement of hardware components and/or logical circuits to perform one or more of the operations of a method and/or system. The processes may be implemented in one or more microprocessors, microcontrollers, embedded microcontrollers, programmable digital signal processors or other programmable devices, along with internal and/or external memory. The processes may also, or instead, be embodied in an application specific integrated circuit, a programmable gate array, programmable array logic, or any other device or combination of devices that may be configured to process electronic signals. It will further be appreciated that one or more of the processes may be realized as a computer executable code capable of being executed on a machine readable medium.

[00233] The computer executable code may be created using a structured programming language such as C, an object oriented programming language such as C++, or any other high-level or low- level programming language (including assembly languages, hardware description languages, and database programming languages and technologies) that may be stored, compiled or interpreted to run on one of the above devices, as well as heterogeneous combinations of processors, processor architectures, or combinations of different hardware and computer readable instructions, or any other machine capable of executing program instructions.

[00234] Thus, in one aspect, each method described above and combinations thereof may be embodied in computer executable code that, when executing on one or more computing devices, performs the steps thereof. In another aspect, the methods may be embodied in systems that perform the steps thereof, and may be distributed across devices in a number of ways, or all of the functionality may be integrated into a dedicated, standalone device or other hardware. In another aspect, the means for performing the steps associated with the processes described above may include any of the hardware and/or computer readable instructions described above. All such permutations and combinations are contemplated in embodiments of the present disclosure.

[00235] Referencing FIG. 26, an example system for operating an inspection robot having a distributed microcontroller assembly is depicted, the distributed microcontroller assembly supporting modular control operations, and allowing for rapid prototyping, testing, reconfiguration of the inspection robot, and swapping of hardware components without requiring changes to the primary inspection control functions of the inspection robot.

[00236] The example system includes an inspection controller circuit 8602 that operates an inspection robot using a first command set 8604. In certain embodiments, the first command set 8604 includes high-level inspection control commands, such as robot positioning and/or movement instructions, instructions to perform sensing operations and/or actuator operations, and may further include instructions using standardized parameters, state values, and the like that are separated from low- level instructions that might be configured for the specific characteristics of hardware components of the inspection robot. For example, an actuator may be responsive to specific voltage values, position instructions, or the like, where the example first command set includes instructions such as whether the actuator should be activated, a down force to be applied by the actuator, a position target value of an actuated component such as a payload or stability assist device, and/or a state value such as “inspecting”, “stability assist stored”, “stability assist deployed”, “payload raised”, etc.

[00237] The example system includes a hardware interface 8606 in communication with the inspection controller circuit 8602, where the hardware interface utilizes the first command set 8604. The example system further includes a first hardware component 8608 that is operatively couplable to the hardware interface 8606, and a second hardware component 8614 that is couplable to the hardware interface 8606. The hardware components 8608, 8614 may include sensors, actuators, payloads, and/or any other device that, when coupled to the inspection robot, communicates and/or is controlled by the inspection robot during inspection operations. In certain embodiments, one or more of the hardware components 8608, 8614 includes a painting device, an actuator, a camera, a welding device, a marking device, and/or a cleaning device. The example first hardware component 8608 includes a first response map 8610, which may include a description of sensor response values (e.g., voltages, frequency values, current values, or the like) provided by the hardware component 8608 and corresponding values used by the inspection robot, such as the represented sensed values (e.g., temperature, UT return time, wall thickness indicated, etc.). Another example first response map 8610 may include a description of actuation command values provided by the inspection robot corresponding to actuator responses for the values. For example, actuation command values may be an actuator position value, where the actuator responses may be voltage values, current values, or the like provided to the actuator. The example second hardware component 8614 includes a second response map 8616. In certain embodiments, the first response map 8610 is distinct from the second response map 8616.

[00238] In certain embodiments, the actuation command values and/or the represented sensed values are more specific to the hardware component than parameters utilized in the first command set 8604. In certain embodiments, as described following, an interface controller 8628 and/or a low- level hardware control circuit (e.g., sensor control circuit 8620) may be present and interposed between the hardware component and the inspection controller circuit 8602. Intermediate controllers or control circuits may be positioned on either side of the hardware interface 8606, and may further be positioned on the respective hardware controller.

[00239] The system includes the inspection controller circuit 8602 controlling the first hardware component 8608 or the second hardware component 8614 utilizing the first command set 8604. The system having the first hardware component 8608 coupled to the hardware interface 8606 has a first inspection capability 8612, and the system having the second hardware component 8614 coupled to the hardware interface 8606 has a second inspection capability 8618. In certain embodiments, the first inspection capability 8612 is distinct from the second inspection capability 8618, such as distinct inspection and/or sensing capabilities, and/or distinct actuation capabilities. The first hardware component 8608 and/or the second hardware component 8614 may include more than one sensor (e.g., a group of sensors having a single interface to the hardware interface 8606), more than one actuator (e.g., a drive module having a drive actuator and a payload actuator), or combinations of these (e.g., a drive module or pay load having at least one sensor and at least one actuator).

[00240] An example system includes at least one of the hardware components 8608, 8614 including a sensor (depicted as the first hardware component 8608 in the example of FIG. 26), and a sensor control circuit 8620 that converts a sensor response 8622 to a sensed parameter value 8626. The example sensor control circuit 8620 is depicted as positioned on the hardware component, and as interposed between the hardware interface 8606 and the inspection controller circuit 8602, although the sensor control circuit 8620 may be positioned in only one of these locations for a given embodiment. The example sensor control circuit 8620 utilizes an A/D converter instruction set 8624 to convert the sensor response 8622. In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8620 performs one or more operations such as debouncing, noise removal, filtering, saturation management, slew rate management, hysteresis operations, and/or diagnostic processing on the sensor response 8622 to determine the sensed parameter value 8626. In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8620 additionally or alternatively interprets the sensor response 8622 by converting the sensor response 8622 from sensor provided units (e.g., voltage, bits, frequency values, etc.) to the sensed parameter value 8626. In certain embodiments, for example where the sensor is a smart sensor or a high capability sensor, the sensor may be configured to provide the sensed parameter value 8626 directly, and/or the sensor control circuit 8620 may be positioned on the sensor to provide the sensed parameter value 8626.

[00241] In certain embodiments, the inspection controller circuit 8602 utilizes the sensed parameter value 8626. The sensed parameter value 8626 may be communicated to the inspection controller circuit 8602 from the sensor control circuit 8620, for example where the interface controller 8628 receives the sensor response 8622, and the sensor control circuit 8620 is interposed between the hardware interface 8606 and the inspection controller circuit 8602. In certain embodiments, the sensed parameter value 8626 may be communicated to the inspection controller circuit 8602 from the interface controller 8628, for example where the interface controller 8628 receives the sensed parameter value 8626 from the sensor control circuit 8620 interposed between the hardware interface 8606 and the sensor.

[00242] An example interface controller 8628 interprets the sensor response 8622 utilizing a calibration map 8630. For example, the calibration map 8630 may include interface information between the first command set 8604 and responses and/or commands from/to the respective hardware component 8608, 8614. In certain embodiments, when a hardware component coupled to the hardware interface 8606 is changed, the interface controller updates the calibration map 8630, for example selecting an applicable calibration map 8630 from a number of available calibration maps 8630, and/or receiving an update (e.g., a new calibration, and/or updated firmware for the interface controller 8628) to provide the updated calibration map 8630. In certain embodiments, the hardware component provides an identifier, such as part number, build number, component type information, or the like, and the interface controller 8628 selects a calibration map 8630 in response to the identifier of the hardware component.

[00243] Referencing FIG. 27, an example inspection robot for performing inspection operations having a distributed microcontroller assembly is depicted, the distributed microcontroller assembly supporting modular control operations, and allowing for rapid prototyping, testing, reconfiguration of the inspection robot, and swapping of hardware components without requiring changes to the primary inspection control functions of the inspection robot. The inspection robot includes a robot body 8702 including an inspection coordination controller 8704 that controls a first inspection utilizing a first command set 8604. The inspection robot includes a hardware interface 8606 in communication with the inspection coordination controller 8704, a first sensor 8706 operatively couplable to the hardware interface 8606, where the first sensor has a first response map 8610, and a second sensor 8708 operatively couplable to the hardware interface 8606, where the second sensor 8708 has a second response map 8616. In certain embodiments, the second response map 8616 is distinct from the first response map 8610. The inspection coordination controller 8704 further controls, using the first command set 8604, the first sensor 8706 or the second sensor 8708.

[00244] In certain embodiments, the first sensor 8706 and second sensor 8708 are swappable, such as where either the first sensor 8706 or the second sensor 8708 can be coupled to the hardware interface 8606, and the inspection coordination controller 8704 can continue to control inspection operations without a change to the first command set 8604. In certain embodiments, the swappable first sensor 8706 or the second sensor 8708 indicates that a same functionality of the inspection robot is available, even where the sensor responses 8622, 8710 are distinct (e.g., the sensors have a same type, can fulfill a same function, and/or they can be utilized with other components of the inspection robot to provide a same function).

[00245] An example inspection robot includes a sensor control circuit 8620 included on the first sensor 8706 and/or the second sensor 8708 (the first sensor 8706 in the example of FIG. 27) that converts the sensor response 8622 to a sensed parameter value 8626. In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8620 provides the sensed parameter value 8626 to the hardware interface 8606. In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8620 converts the sensor response 8622 by performing one or more of debouncing, noise removal, filtering, saturation management, slew rate management, hysteresis operations, and/or diagnostic processing on the sensor response 8622 provided by the sensor. In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8620 performs an A/D conversion on the sensor response 8622 provided by the sensor.

[00246] An example inspection robot includes an interface controller 8628 in communication with the hardware interface 8606, where the interface controller 8628 further receives one of the sensed parameter value 8626 or the sensor response 8622, 8710. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot further includes a sensed value processing circuit 8711 that converts the sensed parameter value 8626 to an inspection value 8712 (e.g., converting a sensed value to a secondary value such as a wall thickness, coating thickness, etc.). An example sensed value processing circuit 8711 provides the inspection value 8712 to the inspection coordination controller 8704, and/or to a model or virtual sensor 8714. In certain embodiments, the model or virtual sensor 8714 utilizes the inspection value 8712 to determine other values in the system.

[00247] An example inspection robot includes two drive modules 8716, 8718, each operatively coupled to a respective hardware interface 8606, 8720. The example system includes the interface controller 8628 interposed between the inspection coordination controller 8704 and each of the hardware interfaces 8606, 8720. The example inspection robot further includes each drive module 8716, 8718 having a respective drive controller 8722, 8724, where each drive controller 8722, 8724 is in communication with the respective hardware interface 8606, 8720. The example includes the drive modules 8716, 8718 and the interface controller 8628 provides for separation between the first command set 8604 and the specific communication protocols, command values, and the like for the drive modules 8716, 8718. In certain embodiments, the example includes the drive modules 8716, 8718 and the interface controller 8628 provides for swap ability and/or reversibility of the drive modules 8716, 8718 between the hardware interfaces 8606, 8720.

[00248] Referencing FIG. 28, an example procedure for operating an inspection robot having a distributed microcontroller assembly is depicted. The example procedure includes an operation 8802 to operate an inspection controller in communication with a first hardware component coupled to a hardware interface utilizing a first command set, where the first hardware component includes a first response map, an operation 8804 to de-couple the first hardware component from the hardware interface, an operation 8806 to couple a second hardware component to the hardware interface, where the second hardware component includes a second response map, and an operation 8808 to operate the inspection controller in communication with the second hardware component utilizing the first command set.

[00249] An example procedure includes one of the response maps including an A/D converter instruction set, and/or where the first response map is distinct from the second response map. An example procedure includes an operation (not shown) to operate an interface controller communicatively coupled to the hardware interface, where the operating of the interface controller includes interpreting data from the first hardware component utilizing the first response map, interpreting data from the second hardware component utilizing the second response map, and communicating with the inspection controller in response to the first command set. In certain embodiments, interpreting data from the first hardware component is performed in a first hardware configuration (e.g., with the first hardware component coupled to the hardware interface), and interpreting data from the second hardware component is performed in a second hardware configuration (e.g., with the second hardware component coupled to the hardware interface).

[00250] An example procedure includes one of the response maps including an A/D converter instruction set, and/or where the first response map is distinct from the second response map. An example procedure includes an operation (not shown) to operate an interface controller communicatively coupled to the hardware interface, where the operating of the interface controller includes providing actuator command values to the first hardware component utilizing the first response map, providing actuator command values to the second hardware component utilizing the second response map, and communicating with the inspection controller in response to the first command set. In certain embodiments, providing actuator command values to the first hardware component is performed in a first hardware configuration (e.g., with the first hardware component coupled to the hardware interface), and providing actuator command values to the second hardware component is performed in a second hardware configuration (e.g., with the second hardware component coupled to the hardware interface). In certain embodiments, the procedure includes an operation to update computer readable instructions accessible to the

[00251] interface controller before operating the inspection controller in communication with one of the hardware components, for example after a swap from the first hardware component to the second hardware component.

[00252] Referencing FIG. 29, an example system 8900 for distributed control of an inspection robot is depicted. The inspection robot may include any embodiment of an inspection robot as set forth throughout the present disclosure. The example system includes an inspection control circuit 8902 structured to operate the inspection robot utilizing a first command set, such as high level operation descriptions including movement commands, sensor commands (e.g., sensor on/off times, sampling rates, etc.), actuator commands (e.g., actuator activation or deactivation, actuator positions, and/or result commands such as applying a selected downforce, position for a payload, position for a sled, etc.). The example system includes a hardware interface 8906 in communication with the inspection control circuit 8902, where the hardware interface utilizes the first command set.

[00253] The example system includes a first hardware component 8908 operatively couplable to the hardware interface 8906, where the first hardware component includes and/or is in communication with a first hardware controller 8910. The first hardware controller 8910 includes a first response map 8912, for example including interface descriptions, A/D mapping, hardware responses to commands, and the like, where the first hardware controller 8910 commands the first hardware component 8908 in response to the first response map 8912 and the first command set 8904.

[00254] The example system includes a second hardware component 8914 operatively couplable to the hardware interface 8906, where the second hardware component includes and/or is in communication with a second hardware controller 8916. The second hardware controller 8916 includes a second response map 8918, and commands the second hardware component 8914 in response to the second response map 8918 and the first command set 8904.

[00255] It can be seen that the system of FIG. 29 provides for an inspection robot controller 802 operable to command inspection operations of the inspection robot, with either the first hardware component 8908 or the second hardware component 8914 coupled to the hardware interface 8906, without a change in the coupled hardware component requiring a change in the inspection robot controller 802 or the first command set 8904.

[00256] The example system 8900 further includes the first hardware controller 8910 utilizing a local command set 8920 to command the first hardware component 8908. For example, the inspection robot controller 802 may store a number of command sets thereon, wherein the first hardware controller 8910 selects one of the number of command sets as the local command set 8920 based on the type of hardware component being controlled, a function of the hardware component (e.g., sensing, a type of sensor, actuating a payload, actuating a sensor position, actuating a down force value, actuating a drive wheel, etc.) and/or the type of command present in the first command set 8904. The utilization of a local command set 8920 allows for the implementation of different hardware component types, while allowing the high level first command set 8904 to operate utilizing functional commands disassociated with the specific hardware components implementing the commands. In certain embodiments, a system 8900 may be changed to be compatible with additional hardware component types, actuator positions (e.g., a payload actuator coupled to a drive module or to a center chassis), by adding to available command sets available as local command sets 8920 without changing the inspection control circuit 8902 or the first command set 8904.

[00257] An example system 8900 includes the first response map 8912 being distinct from the second response map 8918, for example where the first hardware component 8908 is a different type of component than the second hardware component 8914, and/or has different interaction values such as response curves relative to electrical control values.

[00258] An example system 8900 includes a first drive module 8922 (which may be the first hardware component 8908, although they are depicted separately in the example of FIG. 29) having a first drive controller 8924 that determines a first drive signal 8926 in response to the first command set 8904 and a first drive module response map 8928. The first drive module 8922 may include a first motor 8930 (e.g., coupled to a drive wheel of the first drive module 8922) that is responsive to the first drive signal 8926.

[00259] An example system 8900 includes a second drive module 8932 (which may be the second hardware component 8914) having a second drive controller 8934 that determines a second drive signal 8936 in response to the first command set 8904 and a second drive module response map 8938. The second drive module 8932 may include a second motor 8940 that is responsive to the second drive signal 8936.

[00260] In certain embodiments, one of the first drive module 8922 or the second drive module 8932 may be coupled to the hardware interface 8906. Additionally or alternatively, one or both of the drive modules may be coupled to one or more additional hardware interfaces 8960, for example with a first drive module 8922 coupled to a center chassis on a first side, and a second drive module 8932 coupled to the center chassis on a second side. In certain embodiments, the drive controllers 8924, 8934 are configured to provide appropriate drive signals 8926, 8936 to the drive modules 8922, 8932 responsive to the first command set 8904, based on the response maps 8928, 8938 and/or which hardware interface 8960 the drive modules 8922, 8932 are coupled to. In certain embodiments, the first command set 8904 may include a command to move the inspection robot in a desired direction and speed, and the operation of the drive controllers 8924, 8934 allow for proper movement (direction and speed) regardless of which side the drive modules are coupled to. Accordingly, in certain embodiments, the drive modules 8922, 8932 are swappable, and/or reversible, without changes to the inspection control circuit 8902 or the first command set 8904. In certain embodiments, the first drive module response map 8928 is distinct from the second drive module response map 8938, for example where the motors are distinct, where the drive modules 8922, 8932 include different actuators (e.g., a pay load actuator on one, and a stability support device actuator on the other), and/or where the drive modules 8922, 8932 are positioned on opposing sides of the center chassis (e.g., where reversibility management is performed response map 8928, 8938 rather than through interface 8960 detection). In certain embodiments, the first drive signal 8926 is distinct from the second drive signal 8936, even where an identical drive response is desired from the first drive module 8922 and the second drive module 8932. In certain embodiments, the drive signals 8926, 8936 may be a commanded parameter to the motor (e.g., 50% torque), and/or the drive signals 8926, 8936 may be a voltage value or a current value provided to the respective drive motor 8930, 8940. [00261] An example hardware component 8908, 8914 includes a sensor 8942, 8950, where the hardware component 8908, 8914 further includes hardware controllers such as a sensor control circuit 8946, 8954 that converts a sensor response of the sensor (e.g., depicted as 8944, 8952) to a sensed parameter value 8948, 8958. In certain embodiments, the inspection control circuit 8902 utilizes the sensed parameter value 8948, 8958, for example as a representation of a parameter sensed by the respective sensor, as a base sensor value, and/or as a minimally processed sensor value.

[00262] In certain embodiments, the sensor control circuit 8946, 8954 converts the sensor response 8944, 8952 by performing one or more of debouncing, noise removal, filtering, saturation management, slew rate management (e.g., allowable sensor response change per unit time, sampling value, and/or execution cycle), hysteresis operations (e.g., filtering, limiting, and/or ignoring sensor response sign changes and/or increase/decrease changes to smooth the sensed parameter value 8948, 8958 and/or avoid cycling), and/or diagnostic processing (e.g., converting known sensor response 8944, 8952 values that may be indicating a fault, electrical failure, and/or diagnostic condition instead of a sensed value - for example utilizing reserved bits of the sensor response map) on the sensor response 8944 value.

[00263] In certain embodiments, one or more hardware controllers 8910, 8946, 8916, 8954, 8924, 8934 and/or response maps 8912, 8918, 8928, 8938 may be positioned on the inspection robot controller 802, positioned on another controller in communication with the inspection robot controller 802, and/or positioned on the respective hardware component (e.g., as a smart component, and/or as a closely coupled component controller). In certain embodiments, one or more hardware controllers 8910, 8946, 8916, 8954, 8924, 8934 are interposed between the inspection control circuit 8902 and the respective hardware component.

[00264] Referencing FIG. 30, an example procedure to operate distinct hardware devices, such as drive modules, utilizing a same first command set, and/or utilizing a swappable hardware interface, is depicted. The example procedure includes an operation 9002 to operate a first drive module with the first command set, and an operation 9004 to operate a second drive module with the first command set. The example procedure further includes an operation 9006 to determine a next movement value in response to the first command set, an operation 9008 to select a drive command from the first command set (e.g., where the first command set includes a number of additional commands in addition to drive commands), and an operations 9010, 9012 to provide drive command to each of the first drive module and the second drive module.

[00265] In certain embodiments, the example procedure further includes an operation 9014 to determine a first drive signal for the first drive module in response to a first response map for the first drive module, and an operation 9016 to determine a second drive signal for the second drive module in response to a second response map for the second drive module. The example procedure includes operations 9018, 9020 to adjust the first drive module and the second drive module (and/or the first drive signal or the second drive signal), respectively, by an adjustment amount having a common adjustment parameter. In certain embodiments, the procedure includes an operation to determine the common adjustment parameter 9022 as one of a speed parameter, a distance parameter, and/or a direction parameter. For example, the common adjustment parameter 9022 may be utilized to adjust the first drive module in a first direction and the second drive module in an opposite direction to account for the positions of the reversible drive modules with respect to a center chassis of the inspection robot. In another example, the common adjustment parameter 9022 may be utilized to prevent wheel slipping, for example where the inspection robot is turning on a surface, by commanding an inner one of the drive modules to turn slightly slower and/or traverse a smaller distance, and commanding an outer one of the drive modules to turn slightly faster or traverse a larger distance. [00266] In certain embodiments, operations 9018, 9020 to adjust the drive modules (and/or drive module signals) are performed to achieve a target provided by the first command set, where the adjustments do not have a common adjustment parameter, and/or where the adjustments are not adjusted by a same or similar amount (e.g., where a wheel of one of the drive modules is determined to be slipping). The procedure further includes an operation 9024 to interrogate the inspection surface (e.g., perform sensing operations) in response to the first command set.

[00267] Referring to FIGS. 31-33, example methods for inspecting an inspection surface with an inspection robot using configurable payloads are depicted. The inspection robot includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example methods depicted in FIGS. 31-33. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 (FIG. 1) may have one or more payloads 2 (FIG. 1) and may include one or more sensors 2202 (FIG. 78) on each pay load 2.

[00268] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00269] As illustrated in FIG. 31, a first method includes inspecting 9202 an inspection surface using a first payload coupled to a chassis of the inspection robot, decoupling 9204 the first payload from the inspection robot, and selectively coupling 9206 a second payload to the chassis of the inspection robot. As will be explained in greater detail below, the first payload has a first inspection characteristic, and the second payload has a second inspection characteristic that is distinct from the first inspection characteristic. In embodiments, the method further includes inspecting 9208 the inspection surface using the second payload. [00270] In embodiments, the inspection characteristic distinction may be a difference between a configuration of the one or more inspection sensors of the first payload and a configuration of the one or more inspection sensors of the second payload. The configuration difference may be a difference in a type of inspection sensor between the first and second pay loads. In such embodiments, the sensors may be ultrasonic sensors, electromagnetic induction (EMI) sensors, photonic sensors, infrared sensors, ultraviolet sensors, electromagnetic radiation sensors, camera sensors, and/or optical sensors. For example, a first portion of an inspection run may use a first payload having ultrasonic sensors for an initial pass over the inspection surface. In the event an abnormality is found, the first payload may be swapped out for a second payload having optical sensors for use in a second pass over the inspection surface to acquire images of the abnormality. As will be understood, various other combinations of sensors between the first and second payloads may be used.

[00271] In embodiments, both the first pay load and the second pay load may each comprise two or more inspection sensors, and the difference in the configuration of the first payload and the second payload may be a difference in spacing between the inspection sensors on the first payload and the inspection sensors on the second payload. For example, a first inspection pass over the inspection surface may use a payload with a wide spacing between inspection sensors in order to save on the amount of data and/or time needed to capture the status of the inspection surface. In the event that an abnormality is found during the first pass, a second pay load, having a smaller spacing between the sensors than the first payload, may be swapped in place of the first payload for a second inspection run in order to obtain higher quality data of the abnormality, but while taking a longer period of time to cover the same amount of area on the inspection surface as the first payload. As another example, the first inspection pass may cover a first portion of the inspection surface that may require a lower level of resolution, where the first payload has a wider spacing between sensors than the second pay load which is used to cover a second portion of the inspection surface that requires higher resolution. In embodiments, the difference of spacing may be defined at least in part on a difference in a spacing of at least two sleds of the first payload and a spacing of at least two sleds of the second payload.

[00272] In embodiments, the difference in the configuration between the first and second payloads may be a difference between a first directional force applied 9210 on the first payload, e.g., a downward force applied by a first biasing member of the first payload to at least one inspection sensor of the first payload, and a second directional force applied 9212 on the second payload, e.g., a downward force, distinct from the first downward force, applied by a second biasing member of the second payload to at least one inspection sensor of the second payload. In embodiments, the distinction between the first and the second directional forces may be one of a magnitude, angle, and/or direction. The angle may be relative to the inspection surface. For example, in embodiments, the second payload may have a stronger downward biasing force than the first payload. In such embodiments, an operator of the inspection robot may attempt to use the first payload to inspect 9202 the inspection surface only to discover that the sensors of the first payload are having difficulty coupling to the inspection surface. The operator may then recall the inspection robot and swap out the first payload for the second payload to employ the stronger downward biasing force to couple the sensors of the second payload to the inspection surface.

[00273] In embodiments, the difference in the configuration between the first and second payloads may be a difference in a first spacing between at least two arms of the first payload and a spacing between at least two arms of the second payload.

[00274] In embodiments, the difference in the configuration between the first and second payloads may be a difference in spacing defined at least in part on a difference in a first number of inspection sensors on a sled of the first payload and a second number of inspection sensors on a sled of the second payload.

[00275] In embodiments, the distinction between the first inspection characteristic and the second inspection characteristic include at least one of a sensor interface, a sled ramp slope, a sled ramp height, a sled pivot location, an arm pivot location, a sled pivot range of motion, an arm pivot range of motion, a sled pivot orientation, an arm pivot orientation, a sled width, a sled bottom surface configuration, a couplant chamber configuration, a couplant chamber side, a couplant chamber routing, or a couplant chamber orientation.

[00276] In embodiments, the distinction between the first inspection characteristic and the second inspection characteristic is of biasing member type. For example, the first payload may have an active biasing member and the second payload may have a passive biasing member or vice versa. In such embodiments, the active biasing member may be motively coupled to an actuator, wherein a motive force of the actuator includes an electromagnetic force, a pneumatic force, or a hydraulic force. In embodiments, the passive biasing member may include a spring or a permanent magnet. [00277] In embodiments, the distinction between the first inspection characteristic and the second inspection characteristic may be a side of the inspection robot chassis which the first payload is operative to be disposed and a side of the inspection robot chassis which the second payload is operative to be disposed. For example, the chassis may have a first payload interface on a first side and a second payload interface on a second side opposite the first side, wherein first payload may be operative to mount/couple to the first payload interface and lead the chassis and the second payload may be operative to mount/couple to the second payload interface and trail the chassis or vice versa. [00278] Turning to FIG. 32, in embodiments, a second method includes selectively coupling 9302 a first payload to the inspection robot chassis, and selectively coupling 9304 a second payload distinct from the first payload to the inspection robot chassis. The method may further include selectively coupling 9306 a third payload distinct from the first and second payload to the inspection robot chassis. The method may further include selectively coupling 9308 a fourth payload distinct from the first, second and third payloads to the inspection robot chassis. The method may further include coupling yet additional payloads to the inspection robot chassis distinct from the first, second, third and fourth payloads.

[00279] Moving to FIG. 33, a third method includes inspecting 9402 the inspection surface using a first payload coupled to the inspection robot chassis, determining 9406 a characteristic of the inspection surface, decoupling 9408 the first payload from the inspection robot chassis, determining 9410 a second pay load in response to the determined characteristic of the inspection surface, selectively coupling 9412 the second payload to the inspection surface, and inspecting 9414 the inspection surface using the second pay load coupled to the inspection robot chassis.

[00280] Turning now to FIG. 34, an example system and/or apparatus for providing dynamic adjustment of a biasing force for an inspection robot 100 (FIG. 1) is depicted. The example inspection robot 100 includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example system depicted in FIG. 34. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 may have one or more payloads 2 (FIG. 1) and may include one or more sensors 2202 (FIG. 78) on each payload 2.

[00281] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00282] The example system further includes a biasing device 9530 that applies a downward force on at least one sled 1 (FIG. 1) of a payload 2 in a direction towards the inspection surface 500. The biasing device 9530 may be disposed on the inspection robot 100 and have a passive component 9534 and an active component 9532. The passive component 9534 may include a spring, a permanent magnet, weight and/or other device that provides a relatively consistent force. The active component 9532 may include an electromagnet, a suction device, a sliding weight, an adjustable spring (e.g., coupled to an actuator that selectively increases compression, tension, or torsion of the spring), and/or other devices that provide for an adjustable/controllable force. The passive component 9534 and/or the active component 9532 may be mounted to a payload 2, sensors 2202 or other portions of the inspection robot 100 where the components 9532 and 9534 can provide a downward force on the sensors 2202 towards the inspection surface 500. For example, in embodiments, the passive component 9534 may be a permanent magnet that provides a constant baseline amount of force directing the sensors 2202 towards the inspection surface 500 with the active component 9532 being an electromagnet that provides an adjustable amount of force directing the sensors 2202 towards the inspection surface 500 that supplements the force provided by the passive component.

[00283] The example system further includes a controller 802 having a number of circuits configured to functionally perform operations of the controller 802. The example system includes the controller 802 having a sensor interaction circuit 9502, a force control circuit 9506 and a force provisioning circuit 9518. In embodiments, the controller 802 may further include a user interaction circuit 9510 and/or an obstacle navigation circuit 9514. The example controller 802 may additionally or alternatively include aspects of any controller, circuit, or similar device as described throughout the present disclosure. Aspects of example circuits may be embodied as one or more computing devices, computer-readable instructions configured to perform one or more operations of a circuit upon execution by a processor, one or more sensors, one or more actuators, and/or communications infrastructure (e.g., routers, servers, network infrastructure, or the like). Further details of the operations of certain circuits associated with the controller 802 are set forth, without limitation, in the portion of the disclosure referencing FIGS. 34-35.

[00284] The example controller 802 is depicted schematically as a single device for clarity of description, but the controller 802 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or may include portions at least partially positioned with other devices in the system (e.g., on the inspection robot 100). In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may be at least partially positioned on a computing device associated with an operator of the inspection (not shown), such as a local computer at a facility including the inspection surface 500, a laptop, and/or a mobile device. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may alternatively or additionally be at least partially positioned on a computing device that is remote to the inspection operations, such as on a web-based computing device, a cloud computing device, a communicatively coupled device, or the like.

[00285] Accordingly, as illustrated in FIG. 34, the sensor interaction circuit 9502 interprets 9602 a force value 9504 representing an amount of the downward force applied by the biasing device 9530 on a sled 1 in a direction towards the inspection surface 500. The force control circuit 9506 determines 9608 a force adjustment value 9508 in response to the interpreted 9602 force value 9504 and an interpreted 9606 target force value 9536. The force provisioning circuit 9518 provides the force adjustment value 9508 to the active component 9532, which is responsive to the force adjustment value 9508. In other words, the active component 9532 is adjusted 9614 based at least in part on the determined 9608 force adjustment value 9508. In embodiments, determining 9608 the force adjustment value 9508 may include determining 9610 the force adjustment value 9508 to the active component 9532. The biasing device 9530 may then apply 9612 the downward force to the sled 1 and/or sensors 2202, which, as discussed above, may be performed by adjusting 9614 the active component 9532.

[00286] For example, in embodiments, the passive component 9534 may be configured to provide the target force value 9536 to the sled 1 and/or sensors 2202, wherein the target force value 9536 may correspond to an ideal/optimal amount of force for keeping the sensors 2202 coupled to the inspection surface 500 as the sled 1 bounces, jostles and/or otherwise moves in relation to the inspection surface 500 during an inspection run. It will also be understood that the passive component 9534 and the active component 9532 may be configured to collectively provide the target force value 9536.

[00287] Accordingly, in embodiments, the force control circuit 9506 may determine 9608 the force adjustment value 9508 so that the magnitude of the downward force applied by the biasing device 9530 is increased or decreased as conditions encountered by the inspection robot 100 while traversing the inspection surface 500 make it more or less likely that the sensors 2202 will be jostled, bounced, and/or otherwise moved away from an ideal position with respect to the inspection surface 500. In other words, as conditions become more difficult or easy for the sensors 2202 to remain coupled to the inspection surface 500, the target force value 9536 may increase or decrease and the controller 802 may increase or decrease the amount of downward force applied by the active component 9532 in an effort to make the amount of downward force applied by the biasing device 9530, i.e., the sum of the passive component 9534 and active component 9532, to be equal, or nearly equal, to the target force value 9536. In such embodiments, the force adjustment value 9508 may be determined 9608 in response to determining that a coupling quality value is below a coupling quality threshold. As will be appreciated, dynamic adjustment of the amount of downward force provided by the biasing device 9530 improves the overall likelihood that the sensors 2202 will remain coupled to the inspection surface 500 during an inspection run.

[00288] As shown in FIGS. 35 and 36, in embodiments, the obstacle navigation circuit 9514 may interpret 9606 obstacle data 9516 from one or more obstacle sensor, which may be mounted on the inspection robot 100 or located off the inspection robot 100. Such obstacle data 9516 may include the location and/or type of structures on the surface, cracks in the surface, gaps in the inspection surface 500 and/or any other type of information (as described herein) relating to an obstacle which may need to be traversed by the inspection robot 100. In such embodiments, the force control circuit 9506 may update the force adjustment value 9508 when the obstacle navigation circuit 9514 determines 9718 from the obstacle data 9516 that an obstacle is in the path of the inspection robot 100 along the inspection surface 500 and/or when the obstacle data 9516 indicates the obstacle is no longer in the path of the inspection robot 100. For example, where the obstacle data 9516 indicates that an obstacle, e.g., a pipe head, is in the path of the inspection robot 100, the force control circuit 9506 may determine the force adjustment value 9508 to be negative to reduce 9722 the amount of force applied by the biasing device 9530 so that the sensors 2202 and/or sled 1 can more easily move over and/or away from the obstacle. As will be appreciated, in some embodiments, the direction of the fore supplied by the active component 9352 may be reversed to as to lift the sensors 2202 and/or sled 1 away from the inspection surface 500. Upon determining 9718 that the obstacle has been cleared, the force adjustment value 9508 may be made positive to increase 9720 the amount of force applied by the biasing device 9350 to improve sensor 2202 coupling with the inspection surface 500. [00289] As further shown in FIGS. 35 and 36, in embodiments, the force control circuit 9506 may determine 9608 the force adjustment value 9508 such that the amount of the downward force applied by the biasing device 9530 is above a minimum threshold value 9712. For example, in embodiments, the minimum threshold value 9712 may correspond to an amount of force for keeping the sensors 2202 and/or sled 1 from decoupling from the inspection surface 500, e.g., when the inspection surface 500 is inclined and/or vertical with respect to the Earth’s gravitational field. For example, in situations where the inspection robot 100 is inspecting a vertical metal wall, the control circuit may first attempt to traverse an obstacle by reducing an amount of force applied by an electromagnet of the active component 9352 with the minimum threshold value 9712 serving as a safety feature to prevent undesirable departure of the sensors 2202, sleds 1 and/or inspection robot (as a whole) from the inspection surface 500. When the force value 9504 is below the minimum threshold value 9712, or when a determined force adjustment value 9508 would result in the force value 9504 dropping below the minimum threshold value 9712, the force control circuit 9506 may increase 9716 the amount of downward force supplied by the biasing device 9530 by increasing the amount of the force supplied by the active component 9532.

[00290] As yet further shown in FIG. 35, in embodiments, the user interaction circuit 9510 interprets 9604 a force request value 9512. The force adjustment value 9508 may be based, at least in part, on the force request value 9512. For example, the inspection robot 100 may encounter an obstacle and send a notification to an operator. Upon receiving the notification, the operator may determine that the obstacle may be best traversed by decreasing the amount of downward force applied by the biasing device 9530. The operator may then send a force request value 9512 to the controller 802 that calls for decreasing the downward force applied by the biasing device 9530, with the force control circuit 9506 adjusting 9614 the active component 9532 in kind. The operator may also determine that an obstacle is best traversed by increasing the amount of downward biasing force and send a force request value 9512 to the controller 802 calling for an increase in the downward biasing force applied by the biasing device 9530. For example, an operator may detect that the inspection robot 100 has encountered a portion of the inspection surface 500 that is bumpier than expected such that the sensors 2202 are uncoupling, or are about to uncouple, from the inspection surface 500. Accordingly, the operator may increase the amount of biasing force provided by the active component 9532. As another example, the operator may detect that the inspection robot 1 needs to cross a gap and/or small step in the inspection surface 500. In such cases, the operator may decrease the amount of biasing force applied by the active component 9532 to facilitate an easier crossing.

[00291] In embodiments, the minimum threshold value 9712 may be based, at least in part, on the force request value 9512. For example, an operator may detect that the inspection surface 500 is steeper and/or bumpier than originally expected and send a force request value 9512 to the controller 802 that sets and/or increases the minimum threshold value 9712 to reduce the risk of the sensors 2202, sled 1 and/or inspection robot 100 (as a whole) from undesirably departing the inspection surface 500.

[00292] In embodiments, the force adjustment value 9508 may be determined 9608 further in response to determining that an excess fluid loss value exceeds a threshold value. For example, the controller 802 and/or operator may detect that couplant is being lost at a rate faster than desired and, in turn, increase the amount of the downward force applied by the active component 9532 to reduce couplant loss by decreasing the space between the sensors 2202 and the inspection surface 500. [00293] In embodiments, the active component 9532 may be adjusted to compensate for a temperature of the active component 9532, passive component 9534, inspection surface 500 and/or ambient environment. For example, in embodiments where the passive component 9534 is a permanent magnet, the amount of force supplied by the permanent magnet may decrease due to a hot inspection surface and/or hot environmental temperatures. The decrease in the force supplied by the passive component 9534 may be compensated for by increasing the amount of force supplied by the active component 9532. Further, as temperatures changes may affect the efficiency of an electromagnet, in embodiments, the amount of the force called for by the controller 802 of the active component 9532 may need to change as the electromagnet increases and decreases in temperature in order to provide for a consistent amount of force.

[00294] Referring to FIG. 37, an inspection robot 9902 is depicted. The inspection robot 9902 may include an inspection chassis 9904 having a first hardware interface 9906 with a first quick release connection 9908 and a second hardware interface 9936 with a second quick release connection 9938. The example inspection robot 9902 includes an inspection controller 9910 communicatively coupled to the first hardware interface 9906, and structured to control a first component payload 9912 using a first command set 9916. The example inspection robot 9902 includes a first component pay load 9912 operably couplable to the first hardware interface 9906, and having a first component 9922 with a first response map 9914, where the first component 9922 interacts with the inspection controller 9910 using the first command set 9916. The example inspection robot 9902 further includes a second component pay load 9918 that includes a second component 9924 having a second response map 9920 and structured to interact with the inspection controller 9910 using the first command set 9916.

[00295] In certain further embodiments, the first component payload 9922 includes at least two sensors, and/or the second component 9924 includes at least two sensors. In certain further embodiments, the first response map 9914 is distinct from the second response map 9920. In certain embodiments, the first component payload 9922 includes a different number of sensors relative to the second component 9924. In certain embodiments, the hardware interface 9906 includes a couplant connection.

[00296] Example and non-limiting first command set parameters include one or more of: an inspection trajectory for the inspection robot, sensor activation instructions for the inspection robot, couplant flow commands for the inspection robot, position data commands corresponding to inspection data from the first component or the second component for the inspection robot, a result command for the inspection robot, and/or an inspection result command for the inspection robot. [00297] An example inspection robot 9902 includes an intermediary controller 9926 structured to determine whether the first component payload 9912 or the second component pay load 9918 is coupled to the first hardware interface 9906, and to select an appropriate one of the first response map 9914 or the second response map 9920 based on the coupled component payload. An example inspection robot 9902 further includes the intermediary controller 9926 further determining whether the first component pay load 9912 or the second component pay load 9918 is coupled to the first hardware interface 9906 by performing an operation such as: interrogating a coupled pay load for identifying information, analyzing data received from a coupled payload with the first response map 9914 and the second response map 9920 (e.g., determining which response map provides for sensible and/or expected information based on communicated data from the respective component, and/or determining which response map results in an actuator providing the expected response), using the analyzing data received from a coupled payload and determining the coupled payload in response to the analyzing (e.g., determining the type of data, the sampling rate, the range, etc., to determine which component is coupled).

[00298] An example intermediary controller 9926 interprets a corresponding response map 9914, 9920 from the coupled payload, and adjusts communications of the first command set 9910 in response to the corresponding response map 9914, 9920 to determine an adjusted command set 9909, and commands operations of the coupled payload in response to the adjusted first command set. An example intermediary controller 9926 interprets identifying information 9940, 9941 from the coupled component to determine which component is coupled to the hardware interface 9906. An example intermediary controller 9926 interprets inspection data from the coupled payload in response to the corresponding response map.

[00299] An example inspection robot 9902 includes the inspection chassis 9904 having a second hardware interface 9936 including a second quick release connection 9938, wherein the first component payload 9912 and the second component payload 9918 are operably couplable to the second hardware interface 9936. In certain embodiments, the first component payload 9912 and the second component pay load 9918 are swappable between the first hardware interface 9906 and the second hardware interface 9936. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 9902 includes an additional number of payloads 9919, each having a corresponding response map 9932, where the inspection robot 9902 is configured to interact with coupled members of the number of payloads using the first command set 9916. In certain embodiments, the intermediary controller 9926 interacts with the inspection controller 9910 and the coupled payloads, determining response maps and/or adjusting the first command set 9916, thereby isolating operations, command values, and/or parameter values of the inspection controller 9910 from the coupled components, and allowing for utilization of each hardware interface 9906, 9936 for any one or more of, and/or for selected subsets of, the number of components.

[00300] Example and non-limiting component pay loads include one or more components such as: a sensor, an actuator, a welder, a visible marking device, a coating device, and a cleaning tool. An example embodiment includes the first component payload 9922 comprises a first drive module, wherein the second component pay load 9918 comprises a second drive module, where the first hardware interface 9906 comprises a first connection port on a first chassis side of the inspection robot, and wherein the second hardware interface 9936 comprises a second connection port on a second chassis side of the inspection robot.

[00301] Example and non-limiting response maps for components include one or more component descriptions such as: a raw sensor data to processed value calibration, an actuator command description, a sensor output value, an analog-to-digital description corresponding to the component, diagnostic data corresponding to the associated component, and/or fault code data corresponding to the associated component.

[00302] Referencing FIG. 38, an example inspection robot 10002 having swappable and reversible drive modules 10016, 10020 is depicted. The example inspection robot 10002 includes an inspection chassis 10004 having a first hardware interface 10006A and a second hardware interface 10006B, which may include a connecting port on the chassis housing, and/or a drive suspension couplable to a drive module and having rotation allowance/limiting features, translation allowance/limiting features, electrical connections, mechanical connections, and/or communication connections for the drive modules 10016, 10020. The example inspection robot 10002 includes an inspection response circuit 10010, depicted apart from the inspection chassis 10004 but optionally positioned in whole or part on the inspection chassis, and depicted on the inspection robot 10002 but optionally positioned in whole or part away from the inspection chassis. The example inspection response circuit 10010 receives inspection response values (e.g., determined responses for reconfiguration, adjusting an inspection operation, and/or a user request value to adjust operations), and provides a first command set 10012 in response to the adjustments. In certain embodiments, the hardware interfaces 10006A, 10006B include intermediate drive controllers 10008A, 10008B configured to provide commands responsive to the first command set 10012, and further in response to a first response map 10018 and the second response map 10022. In certain embodiments, the example of FIG. 38 allows for the drive modules 10016, 10020 to be coupled to either hardware interface and perform inspection operations and/or adjustments.

[00303] Turning now to FIG. 39, an example system and/or apparatus for operating an inspection robot in a hazardous environment is depicted. The example inspection robot includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot may include a chassis 10102 to which one or more pay loads 10110 are mounted. The payloads 10110 may have a body 10112 to which one or more arms 10114 are mounted. One or more sleds 10118, having one or more inspection sensors 10120, may be mounted to the arms 10114. One or more drive modules 10104, having one, or more, wheel assemblies 10108, may be mounted to the chassis 10102.

[00304] Operations of the inspection robot provide the sensors 10120 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 (FIG. 2) and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 10120 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00305] In embodiments, the one, or more, wheel assemblies 10108 may have a heat resistant magnet 10122 and/or heat resistant magnetic arrangement. The heat resistant magnet 10122 may have a working temperature rating of at least 250 °F. In embodiments, the heat resistant magnet 10122 may have a working temperature rating of at least 80 °C. In embodiments, the heat resistant magnet 10122 may have a working temperature rating of at least 150 °C. In embodiments, the heat resistant magnet 10122 may include a rare earth metal, e.g., neodymium, samarium, and compounds thereof, e.g., NdFeB and SmCo. Materials capable of generating a BHmax greater than forty (40) with a working temperature rating of at least 250 °F may also be included in the magnet. An example heat resistant magnetic arrangement includes a selected spacing of the magnetic hub from the inspection surface (e.g., utilizing the enclosures and/or a cover for the wheel), reducing conduction to the magnetic hub (e.g., a coating for the enclosures and/or the magnetic hub, and/or a wheel cover having a selected low conductivity material), and/or reducing radiative heating to the magnetic hub (e.g., adjusting an absorption coefficient for the hub with polishing and/or a coating, covering a line of sight between the magnetic hub and the inspection surface with a wheel cover, and/or reducing an exposed surface area of the magnetic hub with an enclosure arrangement, wheel cover, and/or coating

[00306] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 40, a system 10400 may include an inspection robot 10402 comprising a chassis 10414, a payload 10404; at least one arm 10406, wherein each arm 10406 is pivotally mounted to a payload 10404; at least two sleds 10408, wherein each sled 10408 is mounted to the at least one arm 10406; a plurality of inspection sensors 10410, each of the inspection sensors 10410 coupled to one of the sleds 10408 such that each sensor is operationally couplable to an inspection surface 10412, wherein the at least one arm is horizontally moveable relative to a corresponding pay load 10404; and a tether 10416 including an electrical power conduit operative to provide electrical power; and a working fluid conduit operative to provide a working fluid. In an embodiment, the working fluid may be a couplant structured to fluidly communicate with at least one sled 10408 to provide for couplant communication via the couplant between an inspection sensor 10410 mounted to the at least one sled 10408 and the inspection surface 10412. In an embodiment, the couplant provides acoustic communication between the inspection sensor and the inspection surface. In an embodiment, the couplant does not perform work (W). In an embodiment, the working fluid conduit has an inner diameter 10512 of about one eighth of an inch. In an embodiment, the tether 10502 may have an approximate length selected from a list consisting of: 4 feet, 6 feet, 10 feet, 15 feet, 24 feet, 30 feet, 34 feet, 100 feet, 150 feet, 200 feet, or longer than 200 feet. In an embodiment, the working fluid may be at least one of: a paint; a cleaning solution; and a repair solution. In certain embodiments, the working fluid additionally or alternatively is utilized to cool electronic components of the inspection robot, for example by being passed through a cooling plate in thermal communication with the electronic components to be cooled. In certain embodiments, the working fluid is utilized as a cooling fluid in addition to performing other functions for the inspection robot (e.g., utilized as a couplant for sensors). In certain embodiments, a portion of the working fluid may be recycled to the base station and/or purged (e.g., released from the inspection robot and/or payload), allowing for a greater flow rate of the cooling fluid through the cooling plate than is required for other functions in the system such as providing sensor coupling.

[00307] It should be understood that any operational fluid of the inspection robot 10402 may be a working fluid. The tether 10416 may further include a couplant conduit 10510 operative to provide a couplant. The system 10400 may further include a base station 10418, wherein the tether 10416 couples the inspection robot 10402 to the base station 10418. In an embodiment, the base station 10418 may include a controller 10430; and a lower power output electrically coupled to each of the electrical power conduit 10506 and the controller 10430, wherein the controller 10430 may be structured to determine whether the inspection robot 10402 is connected to the tether 10416 in response to an electrical output of the lower power output. In embodiments, the electrical output may be at least 18 Volts DC. In an embodiment, the controller 10430 may be further structured to determine whether an overcurrent condition exists on the tether 10416 based on an electrical output of the lower power output. The tether may further include a communication conduit operative to provide a communication link, wherein the communication conduit 10508 comprises an optical fiber or a metal wire. Since fiber is lighter than metal for communication lines, the tether can be longer for vertical climbs because it weighs less. A body of the tether may include at least one of: a strain relief 10420; a heat resistant jacketing; a wear resistant outer layer; and electromagnetic shielding. In embodiments, the tether may include similar wear materials. In embodiments, the sizing of the conduits may be based on power requirements, couplant flow rate, recycle flow rate, or the like.

[00308] In an embodiment, a method may include performing an inspection of an inspection surface ; providing power to an inspection robot through a shared tether ; and providing a working fluid to the inspection robot through the shared tether . The method may further include providing the working fluid between an inspection sensor and the inspection surface wherein the working fluid is a couplant. The method may further include painting the inspection surface , wherein providing the working fluid comprises providing a paint. The method may further include cleaning the inspection surface , wherein providing the working fluid comprises providing a cleaning solution. The method may further include repairing the inspection surface , wherein providing the working fluid comprises providing a repair solution. The method may further include electrically communicating between the inspection robot and a base station via the shared tether . The method may further include providing a low power voltage to an electrical connection between the inspection robot and the base station ; monitoring the electrical connection ; verifying the electrical connection between the inspection robot and the base station ; and determining a connection status value for in response to the verified electrical connection . The method may further include selectively engaging, in response to the connection status value, a high-power voltage to the electrical connection . The method may further include determining a tether fault value ; and selectively engaging, in response to the tether fault value, a higher power output to the shared tether . In embodiments, the tether fault value may be in response to a fault condition, wherein the fault condition comprises a member selected from a list consisting of an overcurrent condition, and a short circuit. In certain embodiments, the method may further include checking for an off-nominal electrical condition, such as the appearance of a high resistance value, noise on the electrical connection, an increasing or decreasing voltage or resistance, or the like, to determine the connection status value. In certain embodiments, the electrical connection may include separate electrical conduits for the low power voltage and/or the high power voltage, and/or both power voltages may be communicated on a same electrical conduit. In certain embodiments, the method includes powering only a portion of the inspection robot, such as low voltage devices, low power devices, and/or low capacitance devices, before the electrical connection is verified. In certain embodiments, the method includes charging capacitive devices with the low power voltage before connecting the high-power voltage, and may further include powering one or more high power devices before the high-power voltage is connected, for example after verifying the electrical connection. The description herein utilizes a low power voltage and a high-power voltage, however it will be understood that the low power voltage may include an otherwise restricted electrical power source, such as a power source having a low current capability, a power source having a resistor in-line with the connection, or the like. Accordingly, while the low power voltage has a voltage lower than the high power voltage in certain embodiments, the low power voltage may additionally or alternatively include a separate restriction or protective feature, and in certain embodiments the low power voltage may have a similar voltage, the same voltage, or a voltage that is a significant fraction (e.g., 25%, 50%, 75%, etc.) of the voltage of the high power voltage.

[00309] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 40, a tether 10416 for connecting an inspection robot 10402 to a base station 10418 may include an electrical power conduit comprising an electrically conductive material; a working fluid conduit defining a working fluid passage therethrough; a base station interface 10432 positioned at a first end of the tether 10416, the base station interface operable to couple the tether 10416 to a base station 10418; a robot interface 10434 positioned at a second end of the tether, the robot interface operable to couple the tether 10416 to the inspection robot 10402; a strain relief 10420; a wear resistance coating; and electromagnetic shielding. The tether may further include a communication conduit, wherein the communication conduit may include an optical fiber or a metal wire. The electrical power conduit may further include a communications conduit. In an embodiment, the working fluid conduit may have an inner diameter of about one eighth of an inch.

[00310] In embodiments, a drive motor in a drive module 4912 (FIG. 18) of the inspection robot 100 may include a power rating that exceeds a combined gravitational force on the inspection robot and the tether. In other words, the drive motors of some embodiments require enough electrical power to transport the weight of the inspection robot 100, the tether and the couplant flowing in the robot 100 and tether, up a vertical face of an inspection surface 500. In embodiments, the inspection surface 500 may have at least one portion with vertical extent greater than or equal to 6 feet, 12 feet, 20 feet, 34 feet, 50 feet, 100 feet, and/or 200 feet.

[00311] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00312]

[00313] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00314]

[00315] Turning to FIG. 41, another method includes releasably coupling 12102 an electrical interface and a mechanical interface of a modular drive assembly to a drive module interface of the inspection robot; positioning 12106 the inspection robot on the inspection surface, thereby engaging at least one wheel of the modular drive assembly with the inspection surface; and powering 12118 the modular drive assembly through the electrical interface, thereby controllably moving the inspection robot along the inspection surface. In embodiments, releasably coupling 12102 the electrical interface and the mechanical interface may include performing 12104 a single engagement operation. In embodiments, the method may further include limiting 12114 a relative rotation between the modular drive assembly and a chassis of the inspection robot through the mechanical interface. In embodiments, the method may further include limiting 12116 a translation movement between the modular drive assembly and a chassis of the inspection robot through the mechanical interface. In embodiment, the method may further include releasably coupling 12110, 12112 an electrical interface and a mechanical interface of a second modular drive assembly to a second drive module interface of the inspection robot. In such embodiments, the drive module interface may be positioned on a first side of a chassis of the inspection robot, and the second drive module interface may be positioned on a second side of the chassis of the inspection robot. In embodiments, controllably moving 12120 the inspection robot on the inspection surface may include independently driving 12122, 12124 the at least one wheel of the modular drive assembly and at least one wheel of the second modular drive assembly. In embodiments, the method may further include independently monitoring 12126, 12128 movement of the at least one wheel of the modular drive assembly and the at least one wheel of the second modular drive assembly. In embodiments, the method may further include determining 12130 a position of the inspection robot based at least in part on the monitored movements of the one or more wheels. In embodiments, the method may further include determining 12132 that at least one of the at least one wheel of the modular drive assembly and/or the at least one wheel of the second modular drive assembly is slipping with respect to the inspection surface based at least in part on the monitored movement of the one or more wheels. In embodiments, the method may further include determining 12134 a passive encoder output from a passive encoder associated with one of the modular drive assembly or the second modular drive assembly. In such embodiments, determining 12136 that at least one of the at least one wheel of the modular drive assembly or the at least one wheel of the second modular drive assembly is slipping with respect to the inspection surface may be based at least in part on the passive encoder output.

[00316] As will be appreciated, embodiments of the modular drive assemblies disclosed herein may provide for the ability to quickly swap out wheel configurations for the inspection robot. For example, a first modular drive assembly having wheels with a first shape corresponding to a first portion of an inspection surface (or the surface as a whole) may be switched out with another modular drive assembly having wheels with a shape corresponding to a second portion of the inspection surface (or a second inspection surface). For example, a first modular drive assembly may be used to inspect a first pipe having a first curvature and a second modular drive assembly may be used to inspect a second pipe having a second curvature.

[00317] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these.

[00318] The depictions of FIGS. 42-43 are non-limiting schematic depictions to illustrate components present in certain embodiments. Certain embodiments may include additional drive modules coupled to the chassis, and/or coupled at different positions relative to the chassis. The position and arrangement of the drive modules to the center chassis may be according to any aspect of the present disclosure, for example including side mounted drive modules having forward and rearward wheels.

[00319] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 42 which depicts an inspection robot, the inspection robot may include a center chassis 12502 including a drive piston 12504 comprising a drive module interface 12508, wherein the drive piston 12504 in a first position places the drive module interface 12508 closest to the center chassis 12502, wherein the drive piston 12504 in a second position places the drive module interface 12508 farthest from the center chassis 12502, and wherein the drive piston 12504 is translatable between the first position and the second position; a drive module 12510, selectively coupled to the drive module interface 12508, and structured to move the center chassis 12502 across an inspection surface; and a drive suspension 12512 pivotally coupling the drive piston 12504 to the drive module 12510. In embodiments, the drive piston 12504 may include a translation limiter 12514 structured to define the second position. The robot may further include a rotation limiter 12518 structured to limit a rotation of the drive module 12510 relative to center chassis 12502. In embodiments, the rotation limiter 12518 may include a slot on an axis, and wherein the drive piston 12504 may be coupled to the axis. The rotation limiter 12518 may limit a rotation of the drive module 12510 relative to the center chassis 12502 to approximately -10 degrees to + 10 degrees. The rotation limiter 12518 may limit a rotation of the drive module 12510 relative to the center chassis 12502, wherein the rotation is unequally distributed relative to 0 degrees. The drive module 12510 may further include a bias spring 12520 structured to bias the drive module 12510 to a desired rotation relative to the center chassis 12502. In an embodiment, an interior of the piston 12504 may include a power connector 12522 structured to transfer power between the center chassis 12502 (aka center module) and the drive module 12510; and a communications connector 12524 structured to transfer digital data between the center chassis 12502 and the drive module 12510.

[00320] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 43, a system may include a robot body 12602 including a first drive piston 12604 operably couplable to a first one of a plurality of drive modules 12610, second drive piston 12608 operably couplable to a second one of the plurality of drive modules 12612 a first drive module 12610 structured to move the robot bodyl2602 across an inspection surface, a second drive module 12612 structured to move the robot body 12602 across the inspection surface first drive suspension 12628 coupling the first drive piston 12604 to the first drive module 12610, and a second drive suspension 12630 coupling the second drive piston 12608 to the second drive module 12612. In an example system, the first drive suspension 12628 is rotationally coupled to the first drive module. An example system includes the second drive module rotationally fixed relative to the second drive piston 12608. An example system includes the second drive suspension 12630 rotationally coupled to the second drive module. In certain embodiments, allowing one or both of the first or second drive module to translate relative to the chassis allows for the inspection robot to comply with variations in the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, allowing for both drive modules to translate may enhance the compliance capability, and/or provide for an improved ability to maintain a payload and/or inspection sensors at a target horizontal position. In certain embodiments, allowing for only one of the drive modules to translate may enhance the stability of the robot on the inspection surface, and/or make handling of the robot easier for an operator.

[00321] In certain embodiments, one or more of the drive pistons, including drive pistons configured for translation, includes a translation limiter, such as any translation limiter as set forth in the present disclosure. An example system includes the interior of each drive piston including a power connector structured to transfer power between the robot body and a corresponding drive module and a communications connector structured to transfer digital data between the robot body and the corresponding drive module. An example system includes one or more of the drive modules including an encoder 12632. An example system includes payload 12634 having a plurality of sensors 12638 structured to collect data about an inspection surface, and a payload controller 12640 structured to transmit data to the robot body via the communications connector.

[00322] Referencing FIG. 44, an example procedure for operating a robot having a multi-function piston coupling a drive module to a center chassis is depicted. The example procedure includes an operation 12702 to translate a drive module to a selected distance from a robot body, an operation 12704 to allow the drive module to passively rotate relative to the center chassis (or robot body) based on the inspection surface, an operation to collect position data from an encoder of the drive module, and an operation 12712 to integrate the position data and inspection data (e.g., from sensors of a pay load), thereby correlating the position data to the inspection data and creating position related inspection data.

[00323] In certain embodiments, the procedure further includes an operation 12714 to actively bias a rotation of the drive module relative to the center chassis, for example toward an inspection position, and/or toward a selected position. The example procedure further includes an operation 12718 to allow an encoder to passively rotate, and a procedure 12720 to bias the passively rotating encoder toward the inspection surface.

[00324] Referring to FIG. 45, enabling an inspection robot to traverse an uneven, non-planar surface may include, providing drive power to a first drive module (step 13502), and providing electrical communications between the first drive module and a center chassis through a first connector coupling the first drive module to the center chassis (step 13503) where the first connector defines a first axis. In some embodiments, drive power may also be provided to a second drive module (step 13504). Electrical communications are provided between the second drive module and a center chassis through a second connector coupling the second drive module to the center chassis (step 13506), where the second connector defines a second axis. Drive power provided to the first drive module selectively rotates the first drive module around the first axis (step 13508). Drive power provided to the second drive module selectively rotates the second drive module around the second axis (step 13510). In embodiments, first and second drive modules are independently drivable. There may be limitations on the extent to which the drive modules may rotate relative to the robot body (center chassis) and the limitations may be distinct between the first and second drive modules. In embodiments, a drive module may be biased to rotate in a specific direction.

[00325] The velocities of the first and second drive modules may be determined (step 13512) by interpreting a first velocity value from a passive encoder (step 13518) and indication of an obstacle determined in response to a difference between the velocities of the first and second drive modules (step 13514). This may be done using an encoder coupled to each of the drive modules, which may be an active encoder (e.g., a sensor coupled to a drive wheel of the drive module) and/or a passive encoder (e.g., an unpowered wheel in contact with the surface, and including a mechanical and/or electrical sensor determining the rotation of the unpowered wheel).

[00326] At wheel of the first drive module may be driven in a direction of travel (step 13508) to move the robot across the surface. In embodiments, a pay load may be lifted in response to an indication of an obstacle in the path (step 13516) or the passive encoder may be biased toward the inspection surface (step 13520). In embodiments, a wheel of the second drive module may also be drive in a direction of travel (step 13510). Wheels of the first and second drive modules are independently drivable and may be driven at different speeds and directions.

[00327] Referencing FIG. 46, an example stability module assembly 13714 is depicted. The example stability module assembly is couplable to a drive module and/or a center chassis of an inspection robot, and is positioned at a rear of the inspection robot to assist in ensuring the robot does not rotate backwards away from the inspection surface (e.g., upon hitting an obstacle, debris, encountering a non-ferrous portion of the inspection surface with front drive wheels, etc.). The example includes a coupling interface 13710, 13706 of any type, depicted as axles of engaging matching holes defined in the stability module assembly 13714 and the coupled device 13720 (e.g., a drive module, chassis, etc.). The example coupling arrangement utilizes a pin 13708 to secure the connection. The example stability module assembly 13714 includes an engaging member 13704 for the inspection surface, which may include one or more wheels, and/or a drag bar. In certain embodiments, the engaging member 13704 is nominally positioned to contact the inspection surface throughout inspection operations, but may additionally or alternatively be positioned to engage the inspection surface in response to the inspection robot rotating away from the inspection surface by a selected amount. The example stability module assembly 13714 includes a biasing member 13716, for example a spring, that opposes further rotation of the inspection robot when the stability module assembly 13714 engages the inspection surface. The biasing member 13716 in the example is engaged at a pivot axle 13718 of the stability module assembly 13714, and within an enclosure or upper portion 13712. In certain embodiments, the upper portion 13712 (or upper stability body) and lower portion 13702 (or lower stability body) are rotationally connected, where the biasing member opposes rotation of the upper portion 13712 toward the lower portion 13702.

[00328] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 47, an inspection robot 14500 may include an inspection chassis 14506; a drive module 14508 coupled to the inspection chassis 14506, the drive module 14508 including a plurality of magnetic wheels 14510, each magnetic wheel 14510 having a contact surface below an inspection side of the inspection chassis 14506; a motor 14512; a gear box 14504 operationally interposed between the motor 14512 and at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510. ; and wherein the gear box 14504 comprises a flex spline cup 14518 structured to interact with a ring gear 14524 and wherein the ring gear 14524 has fewer teeth than the flex spline cup 14518. The gear box 14504 may further include a non-circular ball bearing 14522 mounted to a motor shaft 14516 of the motor 14512 and wherein the non-circular ball bearing 14522 engages with the flex spline cup 14518.

[00329] The inspection robot may further include an output drive shaft 14526, wherein the output drive shaft 14526 may be operatively coupled to the ring gear 14524 and operatively coupled to at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510. In embodiments, the output drive shaft 14526 may be operatively coupled to a second one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510 and wherein the at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510 and the second one of the plurality of magnetic wheels are located on axially opposing sides of the gear box. In embodiments, at least one of the ring gear 14524 or the flex spline cup 14518 includes non-ferrous material. The non-ferrous material may be polyoxymethylene, 316 stainless steel, 304 stainless steel, ceramic, nylon, copper, brass, and/or aluminum.

[00330] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 47, an inspection system may include an inspection robot 14500 including an inspection chassis 14506; a plurality of drive modules 14508 coupled to the inspection chassis 14506, each drive module 14508 including a plurality of magnetic wheels 14510, each magnetic wheel 14510 having a contact surface below a bottom side of the inspection chassis 14506; a motor 14512; a gear box 14504 operationally interposed between the motor 14512 and at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510; and a base station 14502 comprising a power supply circuit 14520 structured to provide power to the inspection robot 14500, wherein the gear box 14504 comprises a flex spline cup 14518 structured to interact with a ring gear 14524 and wherein the ring gear 14524 has fewer teeth than the flex spline cup 14518. The inspection system may further include a tether 14536 structured to transfer power from the power supply circuit 14520 to the inspection robot 14500. In embodiments, the transferred power may operate the motor 14512. The gear box 14504 may further include a non-circular ball bearing 14522 mounted to a motor shaft of the motor and wherein the non-circular ball bearing 14522 engages with the flex spline cup 14518. In embodiments, the gear box 14504 may further include a thrust washer positioned axially adjacent to the flex spline cup 14518 or the ring gear 14524. In embodiments, each drive module 14508 may further include an output drive shaft 14526, wherein the output drive shaft 14526 is operatively coupled to the ring gear 14524 and operatively coupled to at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510. The output drive shaft 14526 may be operatively coupled to a second one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510 and wherein the at least one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510 and the second one of the plurality of magnetic wheels 14510 are located on axially opposing sides of the gear box 14504.

[00331] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 48, an apparatus for tracking inspection data may include an inspection chassis 15202 comprising a plurality of inspection sensors 15208 configured to interrogate an inspection surface; a first drive module 15204 coupled to the inspection chassis 15202, the first drive module 15204 comprising a first passive encoder wheel 15236 and a first non-contact sensor 15238 positioned in proximity to the first passive encoder wheel 15236, wherein the first noncontact sensor 15238 provides a first movement value 15232 corresponding to the first passive encoder wheel 15236; a second drive module 15210 coupled to the inspection chassis 15202, the second drive module 15210 comprising a second passive encoder wheel 15212 and a second noncontact sensor 15214 positioned in proximity to the second passive encoder wheel 15212, wherein the second non-contact sensor 15214 provides a second movement value 15222 corresponding to the second passive encoder wheel 15212; an inspection position circuit 15226 structured to determine a relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to the first movement value 15232 and the second movement value 15222. The term relative position (and similar terms) as utilized herein should be understood broadly. Without limitation to any other aspect or description of the present disclosure, relative position includes any point defined with reference to another position, either fixed or moving. The coordinates of such a point are usually bearing, true or relative, and distance from an identified reference point. The identified reference point to determine relative position may include another component of the apparatus or an external component, a point on a map, a point in a coordinate system, or the like. The first and second movement values 15232, 15222 may be in response to a rotation of the first and second passive encoder wheels 15236, 15212 respectively. In an embodiment, the first and second non-contact sensors 15238, 15214 may be selected from a list consisting of a visual sensor, an electro-mechanical sensor, and a mechanical sensor. The apparatus may further include a processed data circuit 15216 structured to receive the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 and inspection data 15230 from the plurality of inspection sensors 15208; and determine relative position-based inspection data 15220 in response to the relative position and the inspection data 15230. The inspection position circuit 15226 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to a first circumference value 15224 of the first passive encoder wheel 15236 and a second circumference value 15240 of the second passive encoder wheel 15212. The first and second drive modules 15204,15210 may provide the first and second circumference values 15224, 15240 respectively to the inspection position circuit 15226. The inspection position circuit 15226 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to a reference position 15218. In embodiments, the reference position 15218 may be selected from a list of positions consisting of: a global positioning system location, a specified latitude and longitude, a plant location reference, an inspection surface location reference, and an equipment location reference.

[00332] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 49, a method for determining a location of a robot, may include identifying an initial position of the robot 15302; providing a first movement value of a first encoder wheel for a first drive module 15304; providing a second movement value of a second encoder wheel for a second drive module 15308; calculating a passive position change value for the robot in response to the first and second movement values 15310; and determining a current position of the robot in response to the position change value and a previous position of the robot 15322. In embodiments, providing the first movement value comprises measuring a rotation of the first encoder wheel, wherein calculating a passive position change value is done in response to the first movement value and a circumference of the first encoder wheel, wherein calculating a passive position change value 15310 may be done in response to a distance between the first and second encoder wheels. The method may further include receiving a first driven movement value for the first drive module 15312; receiving a second driven movement value for the second drive module 15314; calculating a driven position change value for the robot in response to the first and second driven movement values 15318; determining a difference between the driven position change value and the passive position change value 15320; and setting an alarm value in response to the difference exceeding a maximum position noise value 15324.

[00333] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 50, a system for viewing inspection data may include an inspection robot including an inspection chassis 15404 comprising a plurality of inspection sensors 15406 configured to interrogate an inspection surface; a first drive module 15414 coupled to the inspection chassis, the first drive module 15414 comprising a first passive encoder wheel 15410 and a first non-contact sensor 15408 positioned in proximity to the first passive encoder wheel 15410, wherein the first non-contact sensor 15408 provides a first movement value 15422 corresponding to the first passive encoder wheel 15410; a second drive module 15418 coupled to the inspection chassis, the second drive module 15418 comprising a second passive encoder wheel 15416 and a second non-contact sensor 15440 positioned in proximity to the second passive encoder wheel 15416, wherein the second non-contact sensor 15440 provides a second movement value 15424 corresponding to the second passive encoder wheel 15416; an inspection position circuit 15436 structured to determine a relative position 15432 of the inspection robot 15402 in response to the first movement value 15422, the second movement value 15424, and a reference position 15434; and further structured to provide a position of the inspection robot 15402 relative to the reference position 15434 to a user display device 15441. The system may further include a processed data circuit 15430 structured to: receive the relative position 15432 of the inspection chassis 15404 and inspection data 15426 from a subset of the plurality of inspection sensors 15406; and determine relative position-based inspection data 15428 in response to the position and the inspection data. In embodiments, the user display device 15441 may be further structured to display the relative position-based inspection data 15428. The relative position-based inspection data 15428 may be displayed as an overlay of a map 15444 of the inspection surface. The inspection position circuit 15436 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15432 of the inspection robot in response to a reference position 15434. In embodiments, the reference position 15434 may be selected from a list of positions consisting of: a global positioning system location, a specified latitude and longitude, a plant location reference, an inspection surface location reference, and an equipment location reference. The inspection position circuit 15436 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15432 of the inspection chassis 15404 in response to a first circumference value 15412 of the first passive encoder wheel 15410 and a second circumference value 15420 of the second passive encoder wheel 15416.

[00334] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 48, an apparatus for tracking inspection data may include an inspection chassis 15202 comprising a plurality of inspection sensors 15208 configured to interrogate an inspection surface; a first drive module 15204 coupled to the inspection chassis 15202, the first drive module 15204 comprising a first passive encoder wheel 15236 and a first non-contact sensor 15238 positioned in proximity to the first passive encoder wheel 15236, wherein the first noncontact sensor 15238 provides a first movement value 15232 corresponding to the first passive encoder wheel 15236; a second drive module 15210 coupled to the inspection chassis 15202, the second drive module 15210 comprising a second passive encoder wheel 15212 and a second noncontact sensor 15214 positioned in proximity to the second passive encoder wheel 15212, wherein the second non-contact sensor 15214 provides a second movement value 15222 corresponding to the second passive encoder wheel 15212; an inspection position circuit 15226 structured to determine a relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to the first movement value 15232 and the second movement value 15222. The term relative position (and similar terms) as utilized herein should be understood broadly. Without limitation to any other aspect or description of the present disclosure, relative position includes any point defined with reference to another position, either fixed or moving. The coordinates of such a point are usually bearing, true or relative, and distance from an identified reference point. The identified reference point to determine relative position may include another component of the apparatus or an external component, a point on a map, a point in a coordinate system, or the like. The first and second movement values 15232, 15222 may be in response to a rotation of the first and second passive encoder wheels 15236, 15212 respectively. In an embodiment, the first and second non-contact sensors 15238, 15214 may be selected from a list consisting of a visual sensor, an electro-mechanical sensor, and a mechanical sensor. The apparatus may further include a processed data circuit 15216 structured to receive the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 and inspection data 15230 from the plurality of inspection sensors 15208; and determine relative position-based inspection data 15220 in response to the relative position and the inspection data 15230. The inspection position circuit 15226 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to a first circumference value 15224 of the first passive encoder wheel 15236 and a second circumference value 15240 of the second passive encoder wheel 15212. The first and second drive modules 15204,15210 may provide the first and second circumference values 15224, 15240 respectively to the inspection position circuit 15226. The inspection position circuit 15226 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15228 of the inspection chassis 15202 in response to a reference position 15218. In embodiments, the reference position 15218 may be selected from a list of positions consisting of: a global positioning system location, a specified latitude and longitude, a plant location reference, an inspection surface location reference, and an equipment location reference.

[00335] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 49, a method for determining a location of a robot, may include identifying an initial position of the robot 15302; providing a first movement value of a first encoder wheel for a first drive module 15304; providing a second movement value of a second encoder wheel for a second drive module 15308; calculating a passive position change value for the robot in response to the first and second movement values 15310; and determining a current position of the robot in response to the position change value and a previous position of the robot 15322. In embodiments, providing the first movement value comprises measuring a rotation of the first encoder wheel, wherein calculating a passive position change value is done in response to the first movement value and a circumference of the first encoder wheel, wherein calculating a passive position change value 15310 may be done in response to a distance between the first and second encoder wheels. The method may further include receiving a first driven movement value for the first drive module 15312; receiving a second driven movement value for the second drive module 15314; calculating a driven position change value for the robot in response to the first and second driven movement values 15318; determining a difference between the driven position change value and the passive position change value 15320; and setting an alarm value in response to the difference exceeding a maximum position noise value 15324.

[00336] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 50, a system for viewing inspection data may include an inspection robot including an inspection chassis 15404 comprising a plurality of inspection sensors 15406 configured to interrogate an inspection surface; a first drive module 15414 coupled to the inspection chassis, the first drive module 15414 comprising a first passive encoder wheel 15410 and a first non-contact sensor 15408 positioned in proximity to the first passive encoder wheel 15410, wherein the first non-contact sensor 15408 provides a first movement value 15422 corresponding to the first passive encoder wheel 15410; a second drive module 15418 coupled to the inspection chassis, the second drive module 15418 comprising a second passive encoder wheel 15416 and a second non-contact sensor 15440 positioned in proximity to the second passive encoder wheel 15416, wherein the second non-contact sensor 15440 provides a second movement value 15424 corresponding to the second passive encoder wheel 15416; an inspection position circuit 15436 structured to determine a relative position 15432 of the inspection robot 15402 in response to the first movement value 15422, the second movement value 15424, and a reference position 15434; and further structured to provide a position of the inspection robot 15402 relative to the reference position 15434 to a user display device 15441. The system may further include a processed data circuit 15430 structured to: receive the relative position 15432 of the inspection chassis 15404 and inspection data 15426 from a subset of the plurality of inspection sensors 15406; and determine relative position-based inspection data 15428 in response to the position and the inspection data. In embodiments, the user display device 15441 may be further structured to display the relative position-based inspection data 15428. The relative position-based inspection data 15428 may be displayed as an overlay of a map 15444 of the inspection surface. The inspection position circuit 15436 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15432 of the inspection robot in response to a reference position 15434. In embodiments, the reference position 15434 may be selected from a list of positions consisting of: a global positioning system location, a specified latitude and longitude, a plant location reference, an inspection surface location reference, and an equipment location reference. The inspection position circuit 15436 may be further structured to determine the relative position 15432 of the inspection chassis 15404 in response to a first circumference value 15412 of the first passive encoder wheel 15410 and a second circumference value 15420 of the second passive encoder wheel 15416.

[00337] Referring now to FIG. 51, an apparatus for configuring an inspection robot for inspecting an inspection surface may include a route profile processing circuit 15510 structured to interpret route profile data 15504 for the inspection robot relative to the inspection surface. The planned route implies the way the inspection robot will traverse the surface, and is configurable. The route profile data 15504 may include the planned route, or may simply define the area to be inspected. The apparatus may also include a configuration determining circuit 15512 structured to determine one or more configurations 15518 for the inspection robot in response to the route profile data 15504. The apparatus may further include a configuration processing circuit 15514 structured to provide configuration data 15522 in response to the determined one or more configurations 15518, the configuration data 15522 defining, in part, one or more inspection characteristics for the inspection robot. For example, the configuration data 15522 may be provided to an inspection robot configuration circuit 15516. In another example, the configuration data 15522 may be provided to an operator, such as an operator on a site to help the operator ensure the right parts and capabilities are provided that satisfy the requirements and are responsive to the inspection surface. In yet another example, the configuration data 15522 may be provided to an operator that is remotely positioned, which may allow the operator to configure the robot before leaving for a site, where superior installation/adjustment infrastructure may be available. In embodiments, the apparatus may configure the inspection robot automatically without operator configuration. For example, the apparatus may automatically configure various features of the inspection robot, including one or more of sensor spacing, downforce, sensors activated, routing of robot, sensor sampling rates and/or sensor data resolution, on-surface inspected resolution as a function of surface position, or the like. [00338] In embodiments, and referring to FIG. 52, the one or more inspection characteristics may include at least one inspection characteristic selected from the inspection characteristics consisting of: a type of inspection sensor 15602 for the inspection robot; a horizontal spacing 15610 between adjacent inspection sensors for the inspection robot; a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot; any spacing enforcement such as covering the lanes in separate inspection runs, front/back sensors, non-adjacent sensors, etc.; a magnitude of a downward force 15612 applied to a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; a sled geometry 15628 for a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; a tether configuration 15630 description for the inspection robot; a payload configuration 15632 for a pay load of the inspection robot; a drive wheel configuration 15634 for the inspection robot; a type of a downward force biasing device 15614 for the inspection robot structured to apply a downward force on an inspection sensor of the inspection robot, an inspection sensor width 15604, an inspection sensor height 15608, or the like. The one or more inspection characteristics may include trajectories of any inspection characteristic. For example, the inspection characteristic may be adjustments made during an inspection run, such as Downforce A for portion A of the inspection route, Downforce B for portion B of the inspection route, etc. The tether configuration 15630 description may include conduits applicable (e.g., which ones to be included such as power, couplant, paint, cleaning solution, communication), sizing for conduits (couplant rate, power rating, length), selected outer surface (abrasion resistant, temperature rating), or the like. The pay load configuration 15632 may be a sled/arm spacing, a sled configuration type (e.g., individual sled, sled triplets, new sled types), an arm configuration (articulations available, a couplant support/connection types, sensor interfaces), or the like. A drive wheel configuration 15634 may be a wheel contact shape (convex, concave, mixed); a surface material (coating, covering, material of enclosure for hub); a magnet strength and/or temperature rating, or the like.

[00339] The apparatus may further include a robot configuration circuit 15516 structured to configure the inspection robot in response to the provided configuration data 15506, wherein the robot configuration circuit 15516 is further structured to configure the inspection robot by performing at least one operation selected from the operations consisting of: configuring a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot; configuring at least one of an inspection route and a horizontal spacing between adjacent inspection sensors, thereby performing an inspection operation compliant with an on- surface inspected resolution target; or configuring a downward force biasing device to apply a selected down force to a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot. The on-surface inspected resolution target may include a positional map of the surface with inspected positions, and/or regions having defined inspection resolution targets. The positional map may be overlaid with inspection operations to be performed, sensor sampling rates, and/or sensor data resolutions. The configuration determining circuit 15512 may be further structured to determine a first configuration 15710 of the one or more configurations for a first portion of the inspection surface; and determine a second configuration 15712 of the one or more configurations distinct for a second portion of the inspection surface, wherein the second configuration is distinct from the first configuration. The route profile processing circuit 15510 may be further structured to interpret updated route profile data 15536, such as updated obstacle data 15538, during an inspection operation of the inspection surface by the inspection robot, the configuration determining circuit 15512 may be further structured to determine one or more updated configurations 15520 of the inspection robot in response to the updated route profile data 15536; and the configuration processing circuit 15514 may be further structured to provide updated configuration data 15540 in response to the determined updated one or more configurations 15520. The updated configuration data may include updated inspection sensor type 15616, updated inspection sensor width 15618, an updated inspection sensor height 15620, updated inspection sensor spacing 15622, updated downforce magnitude 15624, updated biasing device type 15626, updated sled geometry 15636, updated tether configuration 15638, updated payload configuration 15640, updated drive wheel configuration 15644, or the like. The apparatus may further include a robot configuration circuit 15516 structured to re-configure the inspection robot in response to the updated one or more configurations 15520. The route profile data 15504 may include obstacle data 15508. [00340] Referring to FIG. 53, a method for configuring an inspection robot 15708 for inspecting an inspection surface may include interpreting route profile data 15702 for the inspection robot relative to the inspection surface; determining one or more configurations 15704 for the inspection robot in response to the route profile data; and providing configuration data 15706 in response to the determined one or more configurations, the configuration data defining, at least in part, one or more inspection characteristics for the inspection robot. The one or more inspection characteristics include at least one inspection characteristic selected from the inspection characteristics consisting of a type of inspection sensor for the inspection robot; a horizontal spacing between adjacent inspection sensors for the inspection robot; a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot; a magnitude of a downward force applied to a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; a sled geometry for a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; a tether configuration description for the inspection robot; a payload configuration for a payload of the inspection robot; a drive wheel configuration for the inspection robot; and a type of a downward force biasing device for the inspection robot structured to apply a downward force to a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot. Providing the configuration data 15706 may include communicating the configuration data to a user device, wherein the user device is positioned at a distinct location from a location of the inspection surface. Communicating the configuration data to the user device may be performed before transporting the inspection robot to a location of the inspection surface. Determining one or more configurations for the inspection robot may be performed during an inspection operation of the inspection robot of the inspection surface. Determining one or more configurations may further include adjusting a configuration 15722 of the inspection robot in response to the determined one or more configurations for the inspection robot during the inspection operation of the inspection robot.

[00341] Adjusting the configuration 15722 of the inspection robot may include at least one operation selected from the operations consisting of: configuring a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot; configuring at least one of an inspection route and a horizontal spacing between adjacent inspection sensors, thereby performing an inspection operation compliant with an on-surface inspected resolution target; or configuring a downward force biasing device to apply a selected down force to a sled housing an inspection sensor of the inspection robot. The method may further include mounting an inspection sensor 15714 to the inspection robot in response to the provided configuration data. The method may further include mounting a drive module 15718 to the inspection robot in response to the provided configuration data. The method may further include adjusting an inspection sensor 15716 disposed on the inspection robot in response to the provided configuration data. Determining one or more configurations 15704 for the inspection robot in response to the route profile data comprises: determining a first configuration 15710 of the one or more configurations for a first portion of the inspection surface; and determining a second configuration 15712 of the one or more configurations for a second portion of the inspection surface, wherein the second configuration is distinct from the first configuration.

[00342] In an embodiment, a system may include an inspection robot comprising a payload comprising at least two inspection sensors coupled thereto; and a controller 802 comprising a route profile processing circuit 15510 structured to interpret 15702 route profile data 15504 for the inspection robot relative to an inspection surface; a configuration determining circuit 15512 structured to determine one or more configurations 15518 for the inspection robot in response to the route profile data 15504; and a configuration processing circuit 15514 structured to provide configuration data 15522 in response to the determined one or more configurations 15518, the configuration data defining, at least in part, one or more inspection characteristics for the inspection robot. The one or more inspection characteristics may include a type of inspection sensor for the inspection robot. The one or more inspection characteristics may include a horizontal spacing between adjacent inspection sensors for the inspection robot. The payload may include an adjustable sled coupling position for at least two sleds, each of the at least two sleds housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors. The payload may include an adjustable arm coupling position for at least two arms, each of the at least two arms associated with at least one of the at least two inspection sensors. Each of the at least two arms further comprises at least one sled coupled thereto, each of the at least one sled housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors.

[00343] The one or more inspection characteristics may include a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot, or any spacing enforcement, such as covering the lanes in separate inspection runs, front/back sensors, non-adjacent sensors, etc. The one or more inspection characteristics may include a magnitude of a downward force 15612 applied to a sled housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors. The one or more inspection characteristics include a sled geometry 15628 for a sled housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors. The one or more inspection characteristics include a tether configuration 15630 description for the inspection robot (e.g. conduits applicable (e.g., which ones to be included such as power, couplant, paint, cleaning solution, communication), sizing for conduits (couplant rate, power rating, length), selected outer surface (abrasion resistant, temperature rating), etc.), the system further including a tether structured to couple a power source and a couplant source to the inspection robot. The one or more inspection characteristics may include a pay load configuration 15632 for the payload of the inspection robot. The payload configuration 15632 may include sled/arm spacing, sled configuration type (e.g., individual sled, sled triplets, new sled types), arm configuration (articulations available, couplant support/connection types, sensor interfaces), or the like. The one or more inspection characteristics may include a drive wheel configuration 15634 for the inspection robot (e.g. wheel contact shape (convex, concave, mixed); surface material (coating, covering, material of enclosure for hub); magnet strength and/or temperature rating). The one or more inspection characteristics may include a type of a downward force biasing device 15614 for the inspection robot structured to apply a downward force to a sled housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors of the inspection robot. The system may further include a robot configuration circuit 15516 structured to configure the inspection robot in response to the provided configuration data. The robot configuration circuit 15516 may be further structured to configure the inspection robot by performing at least one operation selected from the operations consisting of: configuring a horizontal spacing between inspection lanes for an inspection operation of the inspection robot; configuring at least one of an inspection route and a horizontal spacing between adjacent inspection sensors, thereby performing an inspection operation compliant with an on- surface inspected resolution target; or configuring a downward force biasing device to apply a selected down force to a sled housing at least one of the at least two inspection sensors of the inspection robot. The on- surface inspected resolution target may include a positional map of the surface with inspected positions, and/or regions having defined inspection resolution targets which can be overlaid with inspection operations to be performed, sensor sampling rates, and/or sensor data resolutions. The configuration determining circuit 15512 may be further structured to determine 15710 a first configuration of the one or more configurations for a first portion of the inspection surface; and determine 15712 a second configuration of the one or more configurations distinct for a second portion of the inspection surface, wherein the second configuration is distinct from the first configuration. In embodiments, the route profile processing circuit 15510 may be further structured to interpret updated route profile data 15504 during an inspection operation of the inspection surface by the inspection robot; the configuration determining circuit 15512 may be further structured to determine one or more updated configurations 15520 of the inspection robot in response to the updated route profile data 15536; and the configuration processing circuit 15514 may be further structured to provide 15706 updated configuration data 15540 in response to the determined updated one or more configurations. The system may further include a robot configuring circuit 15526 structured to adjust the configuration 15722 the inspection robot in response to the updated one or more configurations. In embodiments, the route profile data may include obstacle data 15508.

[00344] Turning now to FIG. 57, an example system and/or apparatus for traversing an obstacle with an inspection robot 100 (FIG. 1) is depicted. The example inspection robot 100 includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example system depicted in FIG. 59. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 may have one or more payloads 2 (FIG. 1) and may include one or more sensors 2202 (FIG. 78) on each pay load.

[00345] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00346] The example system includes the inspection robot 100 and one or more obstacle sensors 16440, e.g., lasers, cameras, sonars, radars, a ferrous substrate detection sensor, contact sensors, etc., coupled to the inspection robot and/or otherwise disposed to detect obstacle in the path of the inspection robot 100 as it inspects an inspection surface 500.

[00347] The system further includes a controller 802 having a number of circuits configured to functionally perform operations of the controller 802. The example controller 802 has an obstacle sensory data circuit 16402, an obstacle processing circuit 16406, an obstacle notification circuit 16410, a user interface circuit 16414, and/or an obstacle configuration circuit 16424. The example controller 802 may additionally or alternatively include aspects of any controller, circuit, or similar device as described throughout the present disclosure. Aspects of example circuits may be embodied as one or more computing devices, computer-readable instructions configured to perform one or more operations of a circuit upon execution by a processor, one or more sensors, one or more actuators, and/or communications infrastructure (e.g., routers, servers, network infrastructure, or the like). Further details of the operations of certain circuits associated with the controller 802 are set forth, without limitation, in the portion of the disclosure referencing FIGS. 58-59.

[00348] The example controller 802 is depicted schematically as a single device for clarity of description, but the controller 802 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or may include portions at least partially positioned with other devices in the system (e.g., on the inspection robot 100). In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may be at least partially positioned on a computing device associated with an operator of the inspection (not shown), such as a local computer at a facility including the inspection surface 500, a laptop, and/or a mobile device. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may alternatively or additionally be at least partially positioned on a computing device that is remote to the inspection operations, such as on a web-based computing device, a cloud computing device, a communicatively coupled device, or the like.

[00349] Accordingly, as illustrated in FIGS. 57-59, the obstacle sensory data circuit 16402 interprets obstacle sensory data 16404 comprising data provided by the obstacle sensors 16440. The obstacle sensory data may include the position, type, traversal difficulty rating, imagery and/or any other type of information suitable for identifying the obstacle and determining a plan to overcome/traverse the obstacle. In embodiments, the obstacle sensory data 16404 may include imaging data from an optical camera of the inspection robot. The imaging data may be related to at least one of: the body/structure of the obstacle, a position of the obstacle, a height of the obstacle, an inspection surface surrounding the obstacle, a horizontal extent of the obstacle, a vertical extent of the obstacle, or a slope of the obstacle.

[00350] The obstacle processing circuit 16406 determines refined obstacle data 16408 in response to the obstacle sensory data 16404. Refined obstacle data 16408 may include information distilled and/or derived from the obstacle sensory data 16404 and/or any other information that the controller 802 may have access to, e.g., pre-known and/or expected conditions of the inspection surface. [00351] The obstacle notification circuit 16410 generates and provides obstacle notification data 16412 to a user interface device (e.g., reference FIG. 78 and the related description) in response to the refined obstacle data 16408. The user interface circuit 16414 interprets a user request value 16418 from the user interface device, and determines an obstacle response command value 16416 in response to the user request value 16418. The user request value 16418 may correspond to a graphical user interface interactive event, e.g., menu selection, screen region selection, data input, etc.

[00352] The obstacle configuration circuit 16424 provides the obstacle response command value 16416 to the inspection robot 100 during the interrogating of the inspection surface 500. In embodiments, the obstacle response command value 16416 may correspond to a command to reconfigure 16420 the inspection robot and/or to adjust 16422 an inspection operation of the inspection robot. For example, in embodiments, the adjust inspection operation command 16422 may include a command that instructions the inspection robot to go around the obstacle, lift one or more payloads, change a downforce applied to one or more payloads, change a with between payloads and/or the sensors on the payloads, traverse/slide one or more payloads to the left or to the right, change a speed at which the inspection robot traverses the inspection surface, to “test travel” the obstacle, e.g., to proceed slowly and observe, to mark (in reality or virtually) the obstacle, to alter the planned inspection route/path of the inspection robot across the inspection surface, and/or to remove a portion from an inspection map corresponding to the obstacle.

[00353] In embodiments, the obstacle response command value 16416 may include a command to employ a device for mitigating the likelihood that the inspection robot will top over. Such a device may include stabilizers, such as rods, mounted to and extendable away from the inspection robot. In embodiments, the obstacle response command value 16416 may include a request to an operator to confirm the existence of the obstacle. Operator confirmation of the obstacle may be received as a user request value 16418. [00354] In embodiments, the obstacle configuration circuit 16424 determines, based at least in part on the refined obstacle data 16408, whether the inspection robot 100 has traversed an obstacle in response to execution of a command corresponding to the obstacle response command value 16416 by the inspection robot 100. The obstacle configuration circuit 16424 may determine that the obstacle has been traversed by detecting that the obstacle is no longer present in the obstacle sensory data 16404 acquired by the obstacle sensors 16440. In embodiments, the obstacle processing circuit 16406 may be able to determine the location of the obstacle from the obstacle sensory data 16404 and the obstacle configuration circuit 16424 may determine that the obstacle has been traversed by comparing the location of the obstacle to the location of the inspection robot. In embodiments, determining that an obstacle has been successfully traversed may be based at least in part on detecting a change in a flow rate of couplant used to couple the inspection sensors to the inspection surface. For example, a decrease in the couplant flow rate may indicate that the payload has moved past the obstacle.

[00355] The obstacle configuration circuit 16424 may provide an obstacle alarm data value 16426 in response to determining that the inspection robot 100 has not traversed the obstacle. As will be appreciated, in embodiments, the obstacle configuration circuit 16424 may provide the obstacle alarm data value 16426 regardless of whether traversal of the obstacle was attempted by the inspection robot 100. For example, the obstacle configuration circuit 16424 may provide the obstacle alarm data value 16426 as a command responsive to the obstacle response command value 16416. [00356] In embodiments, the obstacle processing circuit 16406 may determine the refined obstacle data 16408 as indicating the potential presence of an obstacle in response to comparing the obstacle data comprising an inspection surface depiction to a nominal inspection surface depiction. For example, the nominal inspection surface depiction may have been derived based in part on inspection data previously acquired from the inspection surface at a time the conditions of the inspection surface were known. In other words, the nominal inspection surface depiction may represent the normal and/or desired condition of the inspection surface 500. In embodiments, the presence of an obstacle may be determined based at least in part on an identified physical anomaly between obstacle sensory data 16404 and the nominal inspection surface data, e.g., a difference between acquired and expected image data, EMI readings, coating thickness, wall thickness, etc. For example, in embodiments, the obstacle processing circuit 16406 may determine the refined obstacle data 16408 as indicating the potential presence of an obstacle in response to comparing the refined obstacle data 16408, which may include an inspection surface depiction, to a predetermined obstacle inspection surface depiction. As another example, the inspection robot may identify a marker on the inspection surface and compare the location of the identified marker to an expected location of the marker, with differences between the two indicating a possible obstacle. In embodiments, the presence of an obstacle may be determined based on detecting a change in the flow rate of the couplant that couples the inspection sensors to the inspection surface. For example, an increase in the couplant flow rate may indicate that the payload has encountered an obstacle that is increasing the spacing between the inspection sensors and the inspection surface.

[00357] In embodiments, the obstacle notification circuit 16410 may provide the obstacle notification data 16412 as at least one of an operator alert communication and/or an inspection surface depiction of at least a portion of the inspection surface. The obstacle notification data 16412 may be presented to an operator in the form of a pop-up picture and/or pop-up inspection display. In embodiments, the obstacle notification data 16412 may depict a thin or non-ferrous portion of the inspection surface. In embodiments, information leading to the obstacle detection may be emphasized, e.g., circled, highlighted, etc. For example, portions of the inspection surface identified as being cracked may be circled while portions of the inspection surface covered in dust may be highlighted.

[00358] In embodiments, the obstacle processing circuit 16406 may determine the refined obstacle data 16408 as indicating the potential presence of an obstacle in response to determining a nonferrous substrate detection of a portion of the inspection surface and/or a reduced magnetic interface detection of a portion of the inspection surface. Examples of reduced magnetic interface detection include portions of a substrate/inspection surface lacking sufficient ferrous material to support the inspection robot, lack of a coating, accumulation of debris and/or dust, and/or any other conditions that may reduce the ability of the magnetic wheel assemblies to couple the inspection robot to the inspection surface.

[00359] In embodiments, the obstacle notification circuit 16410 may provide a stop command to the inspection robot in response to the refined obstacle data 16408 indicating the potential presence of an obstacle.

[00360] In embodiments, the obstacle response command value 16416 may include a command to reconfigure an active obstacle avoidance system of the inspection robot 100. Such a command may be a command to: reconfigure a down force applied to one or more pay loads coupled to the inspection robot; reposition a payload coupled to the inspection robot; lift a payload coupled to the inspection robot; lock a pivot of a sled, the sled housing and/or an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; unlock a pivot of a sled, the sled housing and/or an inspection sensor of the inspection robot; lock a pivot of an arm, the arm coupled to a payload of the inspection robot, and/or an inspection sensor coupled to the arm; unlock a pivot of an arm, the arm coupled to a payload of the inspection robot, and/or an inspection sensor coupled to the arm; rotate a chassis of the inspection robot relative to a drive module of the inspection robot; rotate a drive module of the inspection robot relative to a chassis of the inspection robot; deploy a stability assist device coupled to the inspection robot; reconfigure one or more payloads coupled to the inspection robot; and/or adjust a couplant flow rate of the inspection robot. In certain embodiments, adjusting the couplant flow rate is performed to ensure acoustic coupling between a sensor and the inspection surface, to perform a re-coupling operation between the sensor and the inspection surface, to compensate for couplant loss occurring during operations, and/or to cease or reduce couplant flow (e.g., if the sensor, an arm, and/or a pay load is lifted from the surface, and/or if the sensor is not presently interrogating the surface). An example adjustment to the couplant flow includes adjusting the couplant flow in response to a reduction of the down force (e.g., planned or as a consequence of operating conditions), where the couplant flow may be increased (e.g., to preserve acoustic coupling) and/or decreased (e.g., to reduce couplant losses).

[00361] Turning now to FIGs. 58-59, a method for traversing an obstacle with an inspection robot is shown. The method may include interpreting 16502 obstacle sensory data comprising data provided by an inspection robot, determining 16504 refined obstacle data in response to the obstacle sensory data; and generating 16506 an obstacle notification in response to the refined obstacle data. The method may further include providing 16508 the obstacle notification data to a user interface. The method may further include interpreting 16510 a user request value, determining 16512 an obstacle response command value in response to the user request value; and providing 16514 the obstacle command value to the inspection robot during an inspection run. In embodiments, the method may further include adjusting 16516 an inspection operation of the inspection robot in response to the obstacle response command value. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include stopping 16618 interrogation of the inspection surface. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include updating 16620 an inspection run plan. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include taking 16650 data in response to the obstacle. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include applying a virtual mark 16652. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include updating 16654 an obstacle map. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include acquiring 16656 an image and/or video of the obstacle. In embodiments, adjusting 16516 the inspection operation may include confirming 16658 the obstacle.

[00362] The method may further include reconfiguring 16518 an active obstacle avoidance system. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include adjusting 16624 a down force applied to one or more pay loads coupled to the inspection robot. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include reconfiguring 16626 one or more payloads coupled to the inspection robot. Reconfiguring 16626 the one or more payloads may include adjusting a width between the payloads and/or one or more sensors on the pay loads. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include adjusting 16628 a couplant flow rate. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include lifting 16630 one or more pay loads coupled to the inspection robot. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include locking 16632 and/or unlocking 16634 the pivot of a sled of a payload coupled to the inspection robot. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include locking 16636 and/or unlocking 16638 the pivot of an arm that couples a sled to a body of a pay load or to the inspection robot chassis. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include rotating 16640 the inspection robot chassis. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include rotating 16646 a drive module coupled to the inspection robot. In embodiments, reconfiguring 16518 the active obstacle avoidance system may include repositioning 16642, 16644 a payload coupled to the inspection robot.

[00363] In embodiments, the method may further include determining 16520 whether the inspection robot traversed the obstacle. In embodiments, the method may further include providing 16522 a data alarm in response to determining 16520 that the inspection robot has not traversed the obstacle. [00364] The example of FIG. 60 is depicted on a controller 802 for clarity of the description. The controller 802 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or combinations of these. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may operate a web portal, a web page, a mobile application, a proprietary application, or the like. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may be in communication with an inspection robot, a base station, a data store housing inspection data, refined inspection data, and/or other data related to inspection operations. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 is communicatively coupled to one or more user devices, such as a smart phone, laptop, desktop, tablet, terminal, and/or other computing device. A user may be any user of the inspection data, including at least an operator, a user related to the operator (e.g., a supervisor, supporting user, inspection verification user, etc.), a downstream customer of the data, or the like. [00365] In an embodiment, an apparatus for performing an inspection on an inspection surface with an inspection robot may be embodied on the controller 802, and may include an inspection data circuit 16702 structured to interpret inspection data 16704 of the inspection surface and a robot positioning circuit 16706 structured to interpret position data 16712 of the inspection robot (e.g., a position of the inspection robot on the inspection surface correlated with inspection position data). The example controller 802 includes a user interaction circuit 16708 structured to interpret an inspection visualization request 16714 for an inspection map; a processed data circuit 16710 structured to link the inspection data 16704 with the position data 16712 to determine position-based inspection data 16716; an inspection visualization circuit 16718 structured to determine the inspection map 16720 in response to the inspection visualization request 16714 based on the position-based inspection data 16716. The example controller includes a provisioning circuit 16722 structured to provide the inspection map 16720 to a user device.

[00366] In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include a layout of the inspection surface based on the position-based inspection data 16716, where the layout may be in real space (e.g., GPS position, facility position, or other description of the inspection surface coordinates relative to a real space), or virtual space (e.g., abstracted coordinates, user defined coordinates, etc.). The coordinates used to display the inspection surface may be any coordinates, such as Cartesian, cylindrical, or the like, and further may include any conceptualization of the axes of the coordinate system. In certain embodiments, the coordinate system and/or conceptualization utilized may match the inspection position data, and/or may be transformed from the inspection position data to the target display coordinates. In certain embodiments, the coordinates and/or conceptualization utilized may be selectable by the user.

[00367] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 61 and FIG. 62, the inspection map 16720 may include at least two features of the inspection surface and corresponding locations on the inspection surface, each of the at least two features selected from a list consisting of an obstacle 16808; a surface build up 16802; a weld line 16810; a gouge 16806; or a repaired section 16804. The example features represented on the inspection map 16720 are non-limiting, and any features that may be of interest to a user (of any type) may be provided. Additionally, the depictions of features in FIGS. 61- 62 are non-limiting examples, and features may be presented with icons, color coding, hatching, alert marks (e.g., where the alert mark can be selected, highlighted for provision of a tool tip description, etc.). Additionally or alternatively, the features shown and/or the displayed representations may be adjustable by a user.

[00368] In an embodiment, the inspection data 16704 may include an inspection dimension such as, without limitation: a temperature of the inspection surface; a coating type of the inspection surface; a color of the inspection surface; a smoothness of the inspection surface; an obstacle density of the inspection surface; a radius of curvature of the inspection surface; a thickness of the inspection surface; and/or one or more features (e.g., grouped as “features”, subdivided into one or more subgroups such as “repair”, “damage”, etc., and/or with individual feature types presented as an inspection dimension). In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include a visualization property for the inspection dimension, the visualization property comprising a property such as: numeric values; shading values; transparency; a tool-tip indicator; color values; or hatching values. The utilization of a visualization property corresponding to an inspection dimension allows for improved contrast between displayed inspected aspects, and/or the ability to provide a greater number of inspection aspects within a single display. In certain embodiments, the displayed dimension(s), features, and/or representative data, as well as the corresponding visualization properties, may be selectable and/or configurable by the user.

[00369] In an embodiment, the position data may include a position marker 16812, such as an azimuthal indicator 16811 and a height indicator 16813, and wherein the inspection map 16720 includes visualization properties corresponding to position marker 16812, such as an azimuthal indicator 16811 or a height indicator 16813. The example of FIG. 61 depicts a position marker 16812 for a robot position (e.g., at a selected time, which may be depicted during an inspection operation and/or at a later time based on a time value for the inspection display). An example position marker 16812 may be provided in any coordinates and/or conceptualization. In certain embodiments, the inspection display may include coordinate lines or the like to orient the user to the position of displayed aspects, and/or may provide the position marker 16812 in response to a user input, such as selecting a location on the inspection surface, as a tooltip that appears at a user focus location (e.g., a mouse or cursor position), or the like.

[00370] In an embodiment, and referring to FIG. 67, a method for performing an inspection on an inspection surface with an inspection robot may include interpreting 16902 inspection data of the inspection surface; interpreting 16904 position data of the inspection robot during the inspecting, and linking 16908 the inspection data with the position data to determine position based inspection data; interpreting 16906 an inspection visualization request for an inspection map and, in response to the inspection visualization request, determining 16910 the inspection map based on the position-based inspection data; and providing the inspection map 16912 to a user device. In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include a layout of the inspection surface, wherein the layout is in real space or virtual space. Determining 16910 the inspection map based on the position-based inspection data may include labeling 16914 each inspection dimension of the inspection data. In an embodiment, each inspection dimension may be labeled with a selected visualization property. In the method, the inspection map may be updated 16916, such as in response to a user focus value, wherein updating may include updating an inspection plan, selecting an inspection dimension to be displayed, or selecting a visualization property for an inspection dimension.

[00371] In an embodiment, a system may include an inspection robot comprising at least one payload; at least two arms, wherein each arm is pivotally mounted to a payload; at least two sleds, wherein each sled is mounted to one of the arms; a plurality of inspection sensors, each inspection sensor coupled to one of the sleds such that each sensor is operationally couplable to an inspection surface, wherein the sleds are horizontally distributed on the inspection surface at selected horizontal positions, and wherein each of the arms is horizontally moveable relative to a corresponding pay load; and a controller 802 including an inspection data circuit 16702 structured to interpret inspection data 16704 of the inspection surface; a robot positioning circuit 16706 structured to interpret position data 16712 of the inspection robot; a user interaction circuit 16708 structured to interpret an inspection visualization request 16714 for an inspection map; a processed data circuit 16710 structured to link the inspection data 16704 with the position data 16712 to determine position-based inspection data 16716; an inspection visualization circuit 16718 structured to determine the inspection map 16720 in response to the inspection visualization request 16714 based on the position-based inspection data 16716; and a provisioning circuit 16722 structured to provide the inspection map 16720. In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include a layout of the inspection surface based on the position-based inspection data 16716, wherein the layout is in at least one of: real space; and virtual space. The inspection visualization circuit 16718 may be further structured to identify a feature of the inspection surface and a corresponding location on the inspection surface, wherein the feature is selected from a list consisting of: an obstacle 16808; surface build up 16802; a weld line 16810; a gouge 16806; and a repaired section 16804.

[00372] In an embodiment, an apparatus for displaying an inspection map may include a user interaction circuit 16708 structured to interpret an inspection visualization request 16714 for an inspection map 16720; a processed data circuit 16710 structured to link inspection data 16704 with position data 16712 to determine position-based inspection data 16716; an inspection visualization circuit 16718 structured to determine the inspection map 16720 in response to the inspection visualization request 16714 and the position-based inspection data 16716; and a provisioning circuit 16722 structured to provide the inspection map 16720 to a user display, wherein the user interaction circuit 16708 is further structured to interpret a user focus value corresponding to the inspection map, wherein the user focus value is provided by a user input device. The apparatus may further include an inspection data circuit 16702 structured to interpret inspection data 16704 of an inspection surface; and a robot positioning circuit 16706 structured to interpret position data 16712 of an inspection robot; In an embodiment, the apparatus may further include updating 16916 the inspection map 16720 in response to the user focus value. Updating 16916 the inspection map may include updating an inspection plan, selecting an inspection dimension to be displayed, or selecting a visualization property for an inspection dimension. In some embodiments, updating the inspection map in response to a user focus value can be done without the robot changing anything. In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include two features of the inspection surface and corresponding locations on the inspection surface, each of the two features selected from a list consisting of an obstacle 16808; a surface build up 16802; a weld line 16810; a gouge 16806; or a repaired section 16804. In an embodiment, the inspection data 16704 may include an inspection dimension selected from a list consisting of a temperature of the inspection surface; a coating type of the inspection surface; a color of the inspection surface; a smoothness of the inspection surface; an obstacle density of the inspection surface; a radius of curvature of the inspection surface; and a thickness of the inspection surface. In an embodiment, the inspection map 16720 may include visualization properties for each of the inspection dimensions, the visualization properties each including at least one of numeric values; shading values; transparency; a tool-tip indicator; color values; or hatching values. In embodiments, the position data 16712 may include an azimuthal indicator 16811 and a height indicator 16813, and wherein the inspection map 16720 includes visualization properties for the azimuthal indicator 16811 or the height indicator 16813. In embodiments, the user focus value may include event type data indicating that the user focus value was generated in response to at least one of a mouse position; a menu-selection; a touch screen indication; a key stroke; and a virtual gesture. In embodiments, the user focus value may include at least one of an inspection data range value; an inspection data time value; a threshold value corresponding to at least one parameter of the linked inspection data; and a virtual mark request corresponding to at least one position of the inspection map.

[00373] Referencing FIG. 63, an example inspection map 16720 including a number of frames 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828 is depicted. The frames 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828 may provide views of different inspection dimensions (e.g., separate data values, the same data values at distinct time periods, the same data values corresponding to distinct inspection operations, or the like). Additionally or alternatively, the frames 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828 may provide views of the same inspection dimensions for different positions on the inspection surface, and/or for positions on an offset inspection surface (e.g., a different inspection surface, potentially as a surface for a related component such as a cooling tower, etc.).

[00374] Referencing FIG. 64, an example inspection map 16720 includes pixelated regions 16830, or inspection units. The regions 16830 correspond to positions on the inspection surface, and the size and shape of regions 16830 may be selected according to a spatial resolution on the surface of inspection data, and/or according to a user selection. In certain embodiments, a given region 16832 may depict multiple inspection dimensions, for example using frames 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828, such that a user can determine changes in a parameter over time, view multiple parameters at the same time, or the like in one convenient view. In certain embodiments, a region 16830, and/or a frame 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828 may be selectable and/or focus-able to access additional data, etc. In certain embodiments, a larger view of the frames 16822, 16824, 16826, 16828 may be provided in response to a selection and/or focus of the region 16830.

[00375] Referencing FIG. 65, an inspection data map 16720 is depicted that may include selectable regions and/or frames. The example of FIG. 65 further includes a data representation 16834, with bar graph elements 16836 in the example. In certain embodiments, the bar graph elements 16836 may depict changes in one or more parameters over time and/or inspection sequence, comparisons to inspection data from offset inspection surfaces, and/or data corresponding to multiple parameters for a related region. In certain embodiments, the data representation 16834 may be provided in response to selection and/or focus of a region, and may further be configurable by the user. Referencing FIG. 66, an inspection data map 16720 is depicted that includes a data representation 16834 having a line graph 16838 element - for example depicting progression of a parameter over time, over inspection sequences, or the like.

[00376] In certain embodiments, any data representations herein, including at least data progressions in frames, bar graphs, line graphs, or the like may be determined based on inspection data, previous inspection data, interpolated inspection data (e.g., an estimated parameter value that may have existed at a point in time between a first inspection and a second inspection), and/or extrapolated inspection data (e.g., an estimated parameter value at a future time, for example determined from wear rate models, observed rates of change in regard to the same or an offset inspection surface, etc.).

[00377] Turning now to FIG. 68, an example controller 802 for a system and/or apparatus for providing an interactive inspection map 17004 (FIGS. 70-73) for an inspection robot 100 (FIG. 1) is depicted. The example inspection robot 100 includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors 2202 (FIG. 78) associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example system depicted in FIG. 68. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 may have one or more payloads 2 (FIG. 1) and may include one or more sensors 2202 on each payload 2. [00378] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of an inspection surface 500 (FIG. 2) and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00379] The example system may include the inspection robot 100 and/or the controller 802. As shown in FIG. 68, the controller 802 may have a number of circuits configured to functionally perform operations of the controller 802. For example, the controller 802 may have an inspection visualization circuit 17002 and/or a user interaction circuit 17008 and/or an action request circuit 17012. The example controller 802 may additionally or alternatively include aspects of any controller, circuit, or similar device as described throughout the present disclosure. Aspects of example circuits may be embodied as one or more computing devices, computer-readable instructions configured to perform one or more operations of a circuit upon execution by a processor, one or more sensors, one or more actuators, and/or communications infrastructure (e.g., routers, servers, network infrastructure, or the like). Further details of the operations of certain circuits associated with the controller 802 are set forth, without limitation, in the portion of the disclosure referencing FIGS. 68 and 75.

[00380] The example controller 802 is depicted schematically as a single device for clarity of description, but the controller 802 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or may include portions at least partially positioned with other devices in the system (e.g., on the inspection robot 100). In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may be at least partially positioned on a computing device associated with an operator of the inspection (not shown), such as a local computer at a facility including the inspection surface 500, a laptop, and/or a mobile device. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may alternatively or additionally be at least partially positioned on a computing device that is remote to the inspection operations, such as on a web-based computing device, a cloud computing device, a communicatively coupled device, or the like.

[00381] Accordingly, as illustrated in FIG. 68, inspection visualization circuit 17002 may provide an inspection map 17004 to a user device in response to inspection data 17006 provided by a plurality of sensors 2202 operationally coupled to the inspection robot 100 operating on the inspection surface 500. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example inspection map 17004 depicted in FIG. 68. The user interaction circuit 17008 may interpret a user focus value 17010 from the user device, the action request circuit 17012 may determine an action 17014 in response to the user focus value 17010, and the inspection visualization circuit 17002 may update the inspection map 17004 in response to the determined action 17014.

[00382] Turning to FIG. 69, in embodiments, the inspection map 17004 may include position-based inspection data 17016 such as the location of obstacles, the inspection robot 100, anomalies in the surface 500, markings of interest and/or other features. In embodiments, the inspection map 17004 may include visualization properties 17018 that correspond and/or are linked to inspection dimensions 17040. For example, the inspection dimensions may include characteristics and/or properties of the inspection surface 500 such as temperature 17042, surface coating type(s) 17044, smoothness (or bumpiness) 17048, an obstacle density 17050, a surface radius of curvature 17052, surface thickness 17054 and/or other characteristic of the surface 500. The temperature 17042 may be a surface temperature. The surface coating type 17044 may correspond to a layer of paint or a protective coating for the inspection surface 500. The surface color 17046 may represent the actual color of the surface, e.g., a level of green representing oxidation of a copper surface. The smoothness 17048 may represent a degree of how smooth and/or bumpy the surface 500 is, which may correspond to a level of difficulty the inspection robot 100 may have traversing a particular portion of the inspection surface 500. The obstacle density 17050 may correspond to how dense an identified obstacle may be. For example, how dense a coating of metallic dust may be over the surface 500. The surface radius of curvature 17052 may correspond to how curved a particular portion of the inspection surface may be which may indicate a level of difficulty that the inspection robot 100 may have traversing particular portions of the inspection surface 500. The visualization properties 17018 may include numeric values 17020, shading values 17022, transparency values 17024, pattern values 17026, a tool-tip value 17028, a color value 17030, a hatching value 17032 and/or any other types of features for depicting a varying inspection dimension 17040 across the surface 500. For example, in embodiments, various types of hatching 10732 may be used in the inspection map 17004 to show distinctions between surface coating types 17044 across portion of the inspection surface 500.

Similarly, color values 17030 may be used in the inspection map 17004 to show a temperature 17042 gradient across the inspection surface. As will be appreciated, embodiments encompassing all possible matching/linking combinations between the inspection dimensions 17040 and the visualization properties 17018 used to depict the inspection dimensions 17040 on the inspection map 17004 are contemplated.

[00383] In embodiments, the visualization circuit 17002 may link the positioned-based inspection data 17016 with time data 17034, that may include past time inspection data 17036 and/or future time inspection data 17038. [00384] Turning to FIG. 70, in embodiments, the inspection map 17004 may include one or more frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108. In embodiments, each of the frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108 may depict a distinct inspection dimension 17040. For example, a first frame 17102 may depict a surface temperature 17042 gradient with a color value 17030, a second frame 17104 may depict a surface coating type 17044 with pattern values 17026, a third frame 17106 may depict surface thickness 17054 with numeric values, and/or a fourth frame 17108 may depict a smoothness 17048 with shading values 17022.

[00385] In embodiments, the frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108 may depict a change in an inspection dimension 17040 over time. For example, the four frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108 in FIG. 70 may show a change in a single inspection dimension 17040, e.g., temperature 17042, over four distinct times Ti, T2, T3 and T4. Accordingly, in embodiments, the user focus value 17010 may include one, or more, time values 17056, wherein the visualization circuit 17002 updates the inspection map 17004 in response to the time values 17056. In embodiments, the one or more-time values 17056 may include: a specified time value 17058, a specified time range 17060; a specified inspection event identifier 17062; a trajectory of an inspection dimension over time 17064; a specified inspection identifier 17066. A specified time value 17058 may include: a specific time and/or date, e.g., Saturday May 15th, 2021, at 14:00h (ET); and/or an amount of time referenced in relation to a known time, e.g., two (2) hours from the start of an inspection run. A specified time range 17060 may include a start and end time/date, and/or a specified amount of time from a known point, e.g., the last three (3) hours. A specified inspection event identifier 17062 may include information that identifies a particular event that may have occurred, e.g., the second time an obstacle was encountered. A specified inspection identifier 17066 may include information that identifies a particular inspection, e.g., the second inspection of site “A”.

[00386] In embodiments wherein the time value 17056 is a trajectory of an inspection over timel7064 of an inspection dimension 17040, the inspection dimension over time may be representative of at least one of: a previous inspection run, a predicted inspection run, or an interpolation between two inspection runs. For example, in an embodiment, a first frame 17102 may depict an inspection dimension 17040 at a past time Ti, frame 17106 may depict the dimension as predicted at a future time T3, and frame 17104 may depict an interpolation of frames 17102 and 17106 to provide an estimate of the inspection dimension 17040 at a time T2 between Ti and T3. [00387] A trajectory, as used herein, indicates a progression, sequence, and/or scheduled development of a related parameter over time, operating conditions, spatial positions, or the like. A trajectory may be a defined function (e.g., corresponding values of parameter A that are to be utilized for corresponding values of parameter B), an indicated direction (e.g., pursuing a target

Il l value, minimizing, maximizing, increasing, decreasing, etc.), and/or a state of an operating system (e.g., lifted, on or off, enabled or disabled, etc.). In certain embodiments, a trajectory indicates activation or actuation of a value over time, activation or actuation of a value over a prescribed group of operating conditions, activation or actuation of a value over a prescribed spatial region (e.g., a number of inspection surfaces, positions and/or regions of a specific inspection surface, and/or a number of facilities), and/or activation or actuation of a value over a number of events (e.g., scheduled by event type, event occurrence frequency, over a number of inspection operations, etc.). In certain embodiments, a trajectory indicates sensing a parameter, operating a sensor, displaying inspection data and/or visualization based on inspection data, over any of the related parameters (operating conditions, spatial regions, etc.) listed foregoing. The examples of a trajectory set forth with regard to the presently described embodiments are applicable to any embodiments of the present disclosure, and any other descriptions of a trajectory set forth elsewhere in the present disclosure are applicable to the presently described embodiments.

[00388] As illustrated in FIG. 71, in embodiments, the frames 17102, 17104, 17106 and/or 17108 may depict past and future/predicted paths of the inspection robot 100 over the inspection surface 500. For example, frame 17102 may show a previous path 17110 in which no obstacle was detected. Frames 17104 and 17106 may show other previous paths 17112 and 17114 in which an obstacle was detected and successfully avoided. Frame 17108 may show a proposed path 17116 based at least in part on information learned from one or more of the previous paths 17110, 17112 and/or 17114. [00389] Referring now to FIGS. 69 and 72 in embodiments, the inspection map may include one or more display layers 10734 which, in embodiment, may be collections of features and/or visualization properties that can have their visibility in the inspection map 17004 collectively toggled by setting an activation state value via the visualization circuit 17002 in response to the user focus value 17010. In other words, a user may toggle display of individual layers via the graphical user interface displaying the inspection map 17004. As will be understood, FIG. 72 depicts layers 17118 and 17122 in dashed lines to represent that they have been made inactive, e.g., not visible, while layers 17120 and 17124 are depicted in solid lines to represent that they have been made active, e.g., visible.

[00390] The layers may have an ordering on a z-axis of the inspection map 17004. For example, layer 17118 may be depicted on top of layer 17120, which is depicted on top of layer 17122, which is depicted on top of layer 17124. Each of the layers may correspond to: an inspection dimension 17040, to include surface coating types 17044, part overlays 17074, remaining life 17076, scheduled maintenance 17078 and/or planned downtime 17080. Part overlays 17074 may include depicting schematics and/or actual images of components, e.g., valves, pipe heads, walls, etc., disposed on the inspection surface 500. The remaining life 17076 may include depicting an estimated remaining life expectancy for one or more portions of the inspection surface 500. For example, portions of a metal ship hull may have varying degrees of corrosion depending on the amount of exposure to salt, water, and air, wherein the amount of time until any particular portion needs to be replaced can be shown as remaining life expectancy. As shown in FIG. 73, a layer 17120 may depict one or more downtime/maintenance values, e.g., zones such as spatial depictions of scheduled maintenance 17126 and/or depictions of downtime 17128. The depictions of downtime 17128 and depictions of scheduled maintenance may include information specifying time periods and/or other information regarding the nature and/or cause for the scheduled maintenance and/or downtime.

[00391] Illustrated in FIG. 74 is a method for providing an interactive inspection map. The method may include providing 17202 an inspection map 17004 to a user device, interpreting 17204 a user focus value 17010, determining 17206 an action 17014 in response to the user focus value 17010, updating 17208 the inspection map 17004 in response to the determined action 17014, and/or providing 17210 the updated inspection map 17004. As disused above, the inspection map 17004 may include positioned based inspection data 17016 of an inspection surface 500.

[00392] In embodiments, updating 17208 the inspection map 17004 may include linking 17212 at least two inspection dimensions 17040 to at least two visualization properties 17018 of the inspection map 17004. In embodiments, updating 17208 the inspection map 17004 may include linking 17214 time data 17034, e.g., past time inspection data 17036 and/or future/predicted time inspection data 17038, to the position-based inspection data 17016. In embodiments, updating 17208 the inspection map 17004 may include determining 17216 one or more display frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108 of the inspection map 17004 over one or more periods included in the time data 17034. In embodiments, updating 17208 the inspection map 17004 may include setting 17218 an activation state value of at least one or more display layers 17118, 17120, 17122, 17124. In embodiments, the one or more display frames 17102, 17104, 17106, 17108 may include: an inspection dimension 17040 layer; a surface coating type 17044 layer; a part overlay 17074 layer; a scheduled maintenance 17078 layer; and/or a planned downtime 17080 layer.

[00393] Referencing FIG. 86, an example system 21600 for rapid validation of inspection data provided by an inspection robot is depicted. A system having the capability to perform rapid validation of inspection data provides numerous benefits over previously known systems, for example providing for earlier communication of inspection data to customers of the data, such as an owner or operator of a facility having an inspection surface. Sharing of inspection data with the consumer of the data requires that the data be validated, to manage risk, liability, and to ensure that the inspection data can be utilized for the intended purpose, which may include providing the data to regulatory agencies, for maintenance records, to fulfill contractual obligations, and/or to preserve inspection information that may be later accessed for legal, regulatory, or other critical purposes. Additionally, providing access to the inspection data may be later understood for certain purposes to put the customer on notice of the results indicated by the inspection data. Accordingly, before inspection information is shared to a customer of the data, including before information is made available for access to a customer of the data, validation of the data, for example to ensure that the inspection data collected accurately represents the condition of the inspection surface. Additionally, the availability of rapid validation of inspection data has a number of additional benefits in view of the embodiments of inspection robots and related systems, procedures, and the like, of the present disclosure. For example, rapid validation of inspection data allows for reconfiguration of the inspection robot, allowing for a corrective action to be taken during the inspection operations and achieve a successful inspection operation. The availability of highly configurable inspection robot embodiments further allows for configuring an inspection robot to address issues of the inspection operation that lead to invalid data collection.

[00394] A data validation that is rapid, as used herein, and without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, includes a validation capable of being performed in a time relevant to the considered downstream utilization of the validated data. For example, a validation that can be performed during the inspection operation, and/or before the completion of the inspection operation, may be considered a rapid validation of inspection data in certain embodiments, allowing for the completion of the inspection operation configured to address issues of the inspection operation that lead invalid data collection. Certain further example rapid validation times include: a validation that can be performed before the operator leaves the location of the inspection surface (e.g., without requiring the inspection robot be returned to a service or dispatching facility for reconfiguration); a validation that can be performed during a period of time before a downstream customer (e.g., an owner or operator of a facility including the inspection surface; an operator of the inspection robot performing the inspection operations; and/or a user related to the operator of the inspection robot, such as a supporting operator, supervisor, data verifier, etc.) has a requirement to utilize the inspection data; and/or a validation that can be performed within a specified period of time (e.g., before a second inspection operation of a second inspection surface at a same facility including both the inspection surface and the second inspection surface; within a specified calendar period such as a day, three days, a week, etc.), for example to ensure that a subsequent inspection operation can be performed with a configuration responsive to issues that lead to the invalid data collection. An example rapid validation operation includes a validation that can be performed within a specified time related to interactions between an entity related to the operator of the inspection robot and an entity related to a downstream customer. For example, the specified time may be a time related to an invoicing period for the inspection operation, a warranty period for the inspection operation, a review period for the inspection operation, and or a correction period for the inspection operation. Any one or more of the specified times related to interactions between the entities may be defined by contractual terms related to the inspection operation, industry standard practices related to the inspection operation, an understanding developed between the entities related to the inspection operation, and/or the ongoing conduct of the entities for a number inspection operations related to the inspection operation, where the number of inspection operations may be inspection operations for related facilities, related inspection surfaces, and/or previous inspection operations for the inspection surface. One of skill in the art, having the benefit of the disclosure herein and information ordinarily available when contemplating a particular system and/or inspection robot, can readily determine validation operations and validation time periods that are rapid validations for the purposes of the particular system.

[00395] An example system 21600 includes an inspection robot 21602 that interprets inspection base data including data provided by an inspection robot interrogating an inspection surface with a plurality of inspection sensors. The inspection robot 21602 may include an inspection robot configured according to any of the embodiments or aspects as set forth in the present disclosure. [00396] The example system 21600 includes a controller 21604 configured to perform rapid inspection data validation operations. The controller 21604 includes a number of circuits configured to functionally execute operations of the controller 21604. An example controller 21604 includes an inspection data circuit that interprets inspection base data comprising data provided by the inspection robot interrogating the inspection surface with a number of inspection sensors, an inspection processing circuit that determines refined inspection data in response to the inspection base data, an inspection data validation circuit that determines an inspection data validity value in response to the refined inspection data, and a user communication circuit that provides a data validity description to a user device in response to the inspection data validity value. Further details of an example controller 21604 are provided in the portion referencing FIG. 87. The example system 21600 further includes a user device 21606 that is communicatively coupled to the controller 21604. The user device 21606 is configured to provide a user interface for interacting operations of the controller 21604 with the user 21610, including providing information, alerts, and/or notifications to the user 21610, receiving user requests or inputs and communicating those to the controller 21604, and accessing a data store 21608, for example to provide access to data for the user 21610.

[00397] Referencing FIG. 87, an example controller 21604 for performing operations to rapidly validate inspection data is depicted. The example controller 21604 is compatible for use in a system 21600 such as the system of FIG. 86. The example controller 21604 includes an inspection data circuit 21902 that interprets inspection base data 21910 including data provided by an inspection robot interrogating an inspection surface with a number of inspection sensors. The example controller 21604 further includes an inspection processing circuit 21904 that determines refined inspection data 21916 in response to the inspection base data 21910. The refined inspection data 21916 includes processed data from the inspection base data 21910, such as refined UT sensor data to determine wall thickness values, coating values, or the like, EM sensor data (e.g., induction data, conductive material proximity data, or the like), and/or combined sensor data utilized in models, virtual sensors, or other post-processed values from the inspection base data 21910. The example controller 21604 includes an inspection data validation circuit 21908 that determines an inspection data validity value 21914 that provides a data validity description 21912 in response to the refined inspection data 21916. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, the inspection data validation circuit 21908 determines the inspection data validity value 21914 in response to determining a consistency of the inspection base data 21910 (e.g., comparing a rate of change of the data versus time, sampling values, and/or position on the inspection surface), compared to expected values and/or rationalized values, and/or relative to detected conditions (e.g., a lifted payload and/or sensor, a fault condition of a component of the inspection robot, the presence of an obstacle, etc.) to determine the inspection data validity value 21914.

[00398] The example controller 21604 further includes a user communication circuit 21906 that provides a data validity description 21912 to a user device in response to the inspection data validity value 21914. In certain embodiments, the data validity description 21912 includes an indication that inspection data values are validated, potentially not valid, likely to be invalid, and/or confirmed to be invalid. In certain embodiments, the data validity description 21912 is provided as a layer, dimension, and/or data value overlaid onto a depiction of the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the user associated with the user device is an operator, a user related to the operator of the inspection robot, such as a supporting operator, supervisor, data verifier, etc., and/or a downstream customer of the inspection data. In certain embodiments, information provided with the inspection data validity value 21914, and/or the data and/or format of the inspection data validity value 21914, is configured according to the user. For example, where the user is a downstream customer of the inspection data, the inspection data validity value 21914 may be limited to a general description of the inspection operation, such as to avoid communicating potentially invalid inspection data to the downstream customer. In another example, such as for a user associated with an operator of the inspection information that may be verifying the inspection operation and/or inspection data, the inspection data validity value 21914 may include and/or be provided with additional data, such as parameter utilized to determine that the inspection data validity value 21914 may be low, fault code status of the inspection robot, indicators of the inspection robot condition (e.g., actuator positions, inspection sensors active, power levels, couplant flow rates, etc.).

[00399] In certain embodiments, the controller 21604 includes the user communication circuit 21906 further providing the inspection data validity value 21914 as a notification or an alert, for example in response to determining the inspection data validity value 21914 is not a confirmed valid value. In certain embodiments, the notification and/or alert is provided to the user device, which may be one of several user devices, such as a computing device, a mobile device, a laptop, a desktop, or the like. In certain embodiments, the user communication circuit 21906 provides the notification or alert to the user device by sending a text message, e-mail, message for an application, publishing the notice to a web portal, web pages, monitoring application, or the like, where the communication is accessible to the user device.

[00400] An example user communication circuit 21906 provides at least a portion of the refined inspection data 21916 to the user device in response to determining the inspection data validity value 21914 is not a confirmed valid value. For example, the user communication circuit 21906 may provide the refined inspection data 21916 that is associated with the potential invalidation determination, representative data values from the refined inspection data 21916 that is associated with the potential invalidation determination, and/or data preceding the refined inspection data 21916 that is associated with the potential invalidation determination. In certain embodiments, the parameters of the refined inspection data 21916 that are provided with the data validity description 21912 are configured at least partially in response to a user validity request value 21928.

[00401] An example user communication circuit 21906 further provides refinement metadata 21918 corresponding to the portion of the refined inspection data 21916 provided with the data validity description 21912. Example and non- limiting refinement metadata 21918 values include one or more of: sensor calibration values corresponding to the number of inspection sensors (e.g., calibration settings for the sensors, values used to calculate wall thickness, delay line values, etc.), a fault description for the inspection robot (e.g., faults active, faults in processing such as faults about to be set, faults recently cleared, etc.), a coupling description for the number of inspection sensors (e.g., direct or indirect indicators whether sensor coupling to the inspection surface is successful, such as actuator positions, down force descriptions, couplant pressure parameters, sled positions, etc.), a recoupling operation record for the number of inspection sensors (e.g., re-coupling operations performed over time and/or inspection surface position preceding and/or during the potentially invalid data, for example allowing for determination of an indication of a coupling problem, statistical analysis of re-coupling events, or the like), a scoring value record for the at least a portion of the refined inspection data (e.g., determinations of refined inspection data determined from a primary mode scoring value relative to a secondary mode scoring value, progression of scores over time and/or related to inspection surface position, scores utilized for data collection, ratios of primary mode to secondary mode scores utilized for data collection, etc.), and/or operational data for the inspection robot (e.g., to allow for determination of anomalies in operational data, to confirm that operations are nominal, track trends, or the like).

[00402] An example user communication circuit 21906 provides offset refined inspection data 21920 to the user device in response to determining the inspection data validity value 21914 is not a confirmed valid value. For example, the offset refined inspection data 21920 may include data preceding the refined inspection data 21916 associated with the potentially invalid data, related data such as data taken in a similar position (e.g., a similar vertical position, dating having similar scoring or other operational parameters to the potentially invalid data, or the like). In certain embodiments, the user communication circuit 21906 further provides offset metadata 21922 corresponding to the offset refined inspection data 21920.

[00403] An example inspection data validation circuit 21908 further determines the inspection data validity value 21914 as a categorical description of the inspection data validity status, such as: a confirmed valid value, a suspect valid value, a suspect invalid value, and/or a confirmed invalid value. In certain embodiments, the categorical description may be determined according to the determinations made in response to the information utilized to determine the inspection data validity value 21914 and the confidence in that information. In certain embodiments, where the refined inspection data 21916 has indicators that the data may be invalid (e.g., a fault code, coupling information, etc.) but the data appears to be valid (e.g., consistent with adjacent data, within expected ranges, etc.), the data may be determined as a suspect valid value. In certain embodiments, wherein the refined inspection data 21916 has stronger indicator that the data may be invalid, and/or the data is marginally valid, the data may be determined as a suspect invalid value. In certain embodiments, where a determinative indicator is present that the data is not valid (e.g., a sensor has failed, a position of the sled/sensor is inconsistent with valid data, etc.) and/or indicators that the data is very likely to be invalid, the data may be determined to be confirmed invalid.

[00404] In certain embodiments, the inspection data validation circuit 21908 determines the inspection data validity value 21914 in response to a validity index description 21924, and comparing the validity index description 21924 to a number of validity threshold values (e.g., values determined to relate to validity descriptions, such as valid, invalid, and/or suspected versions of these). In certain embodiments, the validity index description 21924 may be determined by scoring a number of contributing factors to the invalidity determination, and combining the contributing factors into an index for relative comparison of invalidity determinations. An example inspection data validation circuit 21908 further determines the inspection data validity value 21914 in response to a validity event detection 21926. In certain embodiments, certain events provide a strong indication that related data is invalid, and/or provide a determinative indication that related data is invalid. For example, certain fault codes and/or failed components of the inspection robot may indicate that related data may be invalid and/or is more likely to be invalid. In certain embodiments, certain indicators such as a raised payload, a deactivated sensor, or the like, may provide a determinative indication that related data is invalid.

[00405] In certain embodiments, the user communication circuit 21906 further provides the inspection data validity value 21914 as one of a notification or an alert in response to determining the inspection data validity value is not a confirmed valid value. In certain further embodiments, the user communication circuit 21906 further configures a content of the one of the notification or the alert in response to a value of the inspection data validity value 21914, for example providing a more intrusive alert or notification in response to an inspection data validity value 21914 indicating a higher likelihood of invalid data, and/or based on the criticality of the potentially invalid data.

[00406] An example user communication circuit 21906 further interprets a user validity request value 21928 and provides one or more of a portion of the refined inspection data 21916 to the user device in response to the user validity request value 21928, a portion of the refined inspection data 21916 to the user device in response to the user validity request value 21928, offset refined inspection data 21920, and/or offset metadata 21922 corresponding to the offset refined inspection data 21920 in response to the user validity request value 21928.

[00407] Referencing FIG. 88, an example procedure for providing rapid data validation includes an operation 22002 to determine refined inspection data in response to inspection base data provided by an inspection robot interrogating an inspection surface with a plurality of inspection sensors, an operation 22004 to determine an inspection data validity value in response to the refined inspection data, and an operation 22006 to provide a data validity description to a user device in response to the inspection data validity value.

[00408] The example procedure further includes an operation 22008 to determine whether the inspection data validity value indicates that the refined inspection data is a confirmed valid value. In response to the operation 22008 determining the refined inspection data is not a confirmed valid value, the procedure includes an operation 22010 to provide an alert and/or notification to a user device. The example procedure further includes an operation 22012 to provide the refined inspection data and/or metadata corresponding to the refined inspection data, and an operation 22014 to provide offset refined data and/or offset metadata corresponding to the offset refined data. [00409] Referencing FIG. 89, an example procedure for providing rapid data validation includes an operation 22102 to interpret a user validity request value, for example request values relating to alerts and/or notifications to be provided, and/or related to data to be provided to the user in response to a determination that potentially invalid inspection data is found. The example procedure further includes an operation 22104 to configure alerts and/or notifications in response to the user validity request value. The example procedure further includes an operation 22106 to determine an inspection data validity value based on a validity index description and/or a validity event detection. The example procedure further includes an operation 22008 to determine whether the inspection data validity value is a confirmed valid value. In response to the operation 22008 determining that the inspection data validity value is not a confirmed valid value, the procedure includes an operation 22010 to provide an alert and/or notification to the user device. The example procedure further includes an operation 22102 to interpret a user validity request value (e.g., to configure data values provided in response to detected potentially invalid data, and/or to provide alert and/or notification information), and an operation 22108 to configure provided data based on the user validity request value. The example procedure further includes an operation 22110 to provide refined inspection data, offset refined inspection data, and/or metadata for one or more of these, in response to a determination that potentially invalid inspection data is present.

[00410] Referencing FIG. 54, an example controller 16102 is depicted, where the controller 16102 is configured to perform operations for rapid response to inspection data, for example inspection data collected by an inspection robot performing an inspection operation on an inspection surface. The example controller 16102 includes a number of circuits configured to functionally execute certain operations of the controller 16102. The example controller 16102 depicts an example logical arrangement of circuits for clarity of the description, but circuits may be distributed, in whole or part, among a number of controllers, including an inspection robot controller, a base station controller, an operator computing device, a user device, a server and/or cloud computing device, and/or as an application provided at least in part on any one or more of the foregoing. In certain embodiments, the controller 16102 and/or portions of the controller 16102 are utilizable to perform certain operations associated with embodiments presented throughout the present disclosure.

[00411] A response, as used herein, and without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, includes an adjustment to at least one of: an inspection configuration for the inspection robot while on the surface (e.g., a change to sensor operations; couplant operations; robot traversal commands and/or pathing; payload configurations; and/or down force configuration for a payload, sled, sensor, etc.); a change to display operations of the inspection data; a change to inspection data processing operations, including determining raw sensor data, minimal processing operations, and/or processed data values (e.g., wall thickness, coating thickness, categorical descriptions, etc.); an inspection configuration for the inspection robot performed with the inspection robot removed from the inspection surface (e.g., changed wheel configurations, changed drive module configurations; adjusted and/or swapped payloads; changes to sensor configurations (e.g., switching out sensors and/or sensor positions); changes to hardware controllers (e.g., switching a hardware controller, changing firmware and/or calibrations for a hardware controller, etc.); and/or changing a tether coupled to the inspection robot. The described responses are non- limiting examples, and any other adjustments, changes, updates, or responses set forth throughout the present disclosure are contemplated herein for potential rapid response operations. Certain responses are described as performed while the inspection robot is on the inspection surface and other responses are described as performed with the inspection robot removed from the inspection surface, although any given response may be performed in the other condition, and the availability of a given response as on- surface or off- surface may further depend upon the features and configuration of a particular inspection robot, as set forth in the multiple embodiments described throughout the present disclosure. Additionally or alternatively, certain responses may be available only during certain operating conditions while the inspection robot is on the inspection surface, for example when the inspection robot is in a location physically accessible to an operator, and/or when the inspection robot can pause physical movement and/or inspection operations such as data collection. One of skill in the art, having the benefit of the present disclosure and information ordinarily available when contemplating a particular system and/or inspection robot, can readily determine response operations available for the particular system and/or inspection robot.

[00412] A response that is rapid, as used herein, and without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, includes a response capable of being performed in a time relevant to the considered downstream utilization of the response. For example, a response that can be performed during the inspection operation, and/or before the completion of the inspection operation, may be considered a rapid response in certain embodiments, allowing for the completion of the inspection operation utilizing the benefit of the rapid response. Certain further example rapid response times include: a response that can be performed at the location of the inspection surface (e.g., without requiring the inspection robot be returned to a service or dispatching facility for reconfiguration); a response that can be performed during a period of time wherein a downstream customer (e.g., an owner or operator of a facility including the inspection surface; an operator of the inspection robot performing the inspection operations; and/or a user related to the operator of the inspection robot, such as a supporting operator, supervisor, data verifier, etc.) of the inspection data is reviewing the inspection data and/or a visualization corresponding to the inspection data; and/or a response that can be performed within a specified period of time (e.g., before a second inspection operation of a second inspection surface at a same facility including both the inspection surface and the second inspection surface; within a specified calendar period such as a day, three days, a week, etc.). An example rapid response includes a response that can be performed within a specified time related to interactions between an entity related to the operator of the inspection robot and an entity related to a downstream customer. For example, the specified time may be a time related to an invoicing period for the inspection operation, a warranty period for the inspection operation, a review period for the inspection operation, and or a correction period for the inspection operation. Any one or more of the specified times related to interactions between the entities may be defined by contractual terms related to the inspection operation, industry standard practices related to the inspection operation, an understanding developed between the entities related to the inspection operation, and/or the ongoing conduct of the entities for a number inspection operations related to the inspection operation, where the number of inspection operations may be inspection operations for related facilities, related inspection surfaces, and/or previous inspection operations for the inspection surface. One of skill in the art, having the benefit of the disclosure herein and information ordinarily available when contemplating a particular system and/or inspection robot, can readily determine response operations and response time periods that are rapid responses for the purposes of the particular system.

[00413] Certain considerations for determining whether a response is a rapid response include, without limitation, one or more of: the purpose of the inspection operation, how the downstream customer will utilize the inspection data from the inspection operation, and/or time periods related to the utilization of the inspection data; entity interaction information such as time periods wherein inspection data can be updated, corrected, improved, and/or enhanced and still meet contractual obligations, customer expectations, and/or industry standard obligations related to the inspection data; source information related to the response, such as whether the response addresses an additional request for the inspection operation after the initial inspection operation was performed, whether the response addresses initial requirements for the inspection operation that were available before the inspection operation was commenced, whether the response addresses unexpected aspects of the inspection surface and/or facility that were found during the inspection operations, whether the response addresses an issue that is attributable to the downstream customer and/or facility owner or operator, such as: inspection surface has a different configuration than was indicated at the time the inspection operation was requested; the facility owner or operator has provided inspection conditions that are different than planned conditions, such as couplant availability, couplant composition, couplant temperature, distance from an available base station location to the inspection surface, coating composition or thickness related to the inspection surface, vertical extent of the inspection surface, geometry of the inspection surface such as pipe diameters and/or tank geometry, availability of network infrastructure at the facility, availability of position determination support infrastructure at the facility, operating conditions of the inspection surface (e.g., temperature, obstacles, etc.); additional inspected conditions are requested than were indicated at the time of the inspection operation was requested; and/or additional inspection robot capabilities such as marking, repair, and/or cleaning are requested than were indicated at the time the inspection operation was requested. [00414] The example controller 16102 includes an inspection data circuit 16104 that interprets inspection base data 16106 (e.g., raw sensor data and/or minimally processed data inspection sensors) provided by an inspection robot 16140 interrogating an inspection surface with a number of inspection sensors 16142. The example controller 16102 further includes an inspection processing circuit 16108 that determines refined inspection data 16110 (e.g., processed inspection data, determined state values and/or categories related to the inspection surface from the inspection data, data values configured for depiction or display on a user device, and/or any other refined inspection data according to the present disclosure) in response to the inspection base data 16106, and an inspection configuration circuit 16112 that determines an inspection response value 16114 in response to the refined inspection data 16110. The example controller 16102 includes an inspection response circuit 16116 that provides an inspection command value 16118 in response to the inspection response value 16114.

[00415] Example and non-limiting inspection command values 16118 include one or more commands configured for communication to the inspection robot 16140, such that the inspection robot 16140 can change a configuration aspect (e.g., a sensor setting and/or enable value; an actuator setting or position; an inspection plan such as inspection route and/or inspection operations to be performed for selected regions of the inspection surface) in response to the inspection command value 16118. Additionally or alternatively, inspection command values 16118 may be proved to any other aspect of a system including the controller 16102, including without limitation command values to adjust inspection data displays, inspection data processing operations, inspection robot configurations communicated to an operator (and/or operator device) for adjustment of the inspection robot configuration at the location of the inspection surface, and/or inspection robot configurations communicated to a user (and/or user device) related to the operator of the inspection robot, such as a supporting operator, supervisor, data verifier of the inspection data.

[00416] In certain embodiments, the inspection configuration circuit 16112 provides the inspection command values 16118 during the interrogating of the inspection surface by the inspection robot 16140, for example to provide for configuration updates during the inspection operation. Additionally or alternatively, the inspection configuration circuit 16112 provides the inspection command values 16118 to provide for a rapid response configuration of the inspection robot, to provide for configuration updates within a time period that would be considered a rapid response for a system including the controller 16102.

[00417] In certain embodiments, the controller 16102 includes a user communication circuit 16120 that provides the refined inspection data 16110 to a user device 16124, and receives a user response command 16122, where the inspection configuration circuit 16112 further determines the inspection response value 16114 in response to the user response command 16122. For example, the user device 16124 may be a device accessible to a user such as a downstream customer of the inspection data, allowing for the user to make additional inspection requests, to change conditions that are determined from the inspection data, or the like, during the inspection operations and/or within a time period consistent with a rapid response time period. In another example, the user device 16124 may be a device accessible to a user related to the operator of the inspection robot, such as a supporting operator, supervisor, data verifier of the inspection data.

[00418] In a further example, the user observes the refined inspection data 16110, such as in a display or visualization of the inspection data, and provides the user response command 16122 in response to the refined inspection data 16110, for example requesting that additional data or data types be collected, requesting that additional conditions (e.g., anomalies, damage, condition and/or thickness of a coating, higher resolution determinations - either spatial resolution such as closer or more sparse data collection positions, or sensed data resolution such as higher or lower precision sensing values, etc.) be inspected, extending the inspection surface region to be inspected, and/or omitting inspection of regions of the inspection surface that were originally planned for inspection. In certain embodiments, the user response command 16122 allows the user to change inspection operations in response to the results of the inspection operations, for example where the inspection surface is found to be in a better or worse condition than expected, where an unexpected condition or data value is detected during the inspection, and/or where external considerations to the inspection occur (e.g., more or less time are available for the inspection, a system failure occurs related to the facility or an offset facility, or the like) and the user wants to make a change to the inspection operations in response to the external condition. In certain embodiments, the user response command 16122 allows for the user to change inspection operations in response to suspected invalid data (e.g., updating sensor calibrations, performing coupling operations to ensure acoustic coupling between a sensor and the inspection surface, and/or repeating inspection operations to ensure that the inspection data is repeatable for a region of the inspection surface), in response to a condition of the inspection surface such as an assumed value (e.g., wall thickness, coating thickness and/or composition, and/or presence of debris) that may affect processing the refined inspection data 16110, allowing for corrections or updates to sensor settings, couplant flow rates, down force provisions, speed of the inspection robot, distribution of sensors, etc. responsive to the difference in the assumed value and the inspection determined condition of the inspection surface.

[00419] An example controller 16102 further includes a publishing circuit 16128 that provides the refined inspection data 16110 to a remove server 16130, which may be a computing device communicatively coupled to the controller 16102 and one or more user devices 16124, for example to operate a web portal, web page, mobile application, proprietary application, database, API related to the refined inspection data 16110, and/or that operates as a data store for inspection base data 16106 and/or refined inspection data 16110. In the example, the user communication circuit 16120 receives the user response command 16122, and the inspection configuration circuit 16112 determines the inspection response value 16114 in response to the user response command 16122. [00420] An example controller 16102 includes an inspection map configuration circuit that updates an inspection map 16134 in response to the inspection command value 16118. An example inspection map 16134 includes one or more of: planned inspection region(s) of the inspection surface; inspection operations to be performed for each of one or more regions of the inspection surface; and/or configurations of the inspection robot (e.g., down force, payload configurations, sensor distributions, sensor types to be utilized, and/or sled configurations such as ramp heights, slope, and/or pivot arrangements) for each of one or more regions of the inspection surface. An example controller 16102 further includes a sensor reconfiguration circuit 16138 that provides a configuration parameter 16136 to the inspection robot 16140 in response to a reconfiguration command (e.g., sensor configuration parameters responsive to the inspection map and/or updates to the inspection map). In certain embodiments, an update to the inspection map 16134 includes the reconfiguration command, and/or includes an update to a travel path of the inspection robot 16140. An example reconfiguration command includes a change to at attribute such as a sensor spacing (e.g., horizontal and/or vertical), a couplant flow (e.g., a rate of flow and/or a change to a couplant flow re-coupling operation timing, triggering conditions, and/or flow rate), and/or a force on an inspection sensor (e.g., an active or passive down force, and/or a change in operations of a biasing member and/or an actuator of a pay load, arm, and/or sled associated with the inspection sensor). An example update to the travel path of the inspection robot 16140 includes an update to re-traverse a portion of the inspection surface. An example update to the travel path of the inspection robot 16140 includes an update to an x-y coverage resolution of the inspection robot 16140 (e.g., a macro resolution, such as a distance between inspected regions of a payload, a distance between horizontal inspection lanes; and/or a micro-resolution such as a distance between adjacent sensors of a pay load and/or of the inspection robot). [00421] The example utilizes x-y coverage resolution to illustrate the inspection surface as a two- dimensional surface having a generally horizontal (or perpendicular to the travel direction of the inspection robot) and vertical (or parallel to the travel direction of the inspection robot) component of the two-dimensional surface. However, it is understood that the inspection surface may have a three-dimensional component, such as a region within a tank having a surface curvature with three dimensions, a region having a number of pipes or other features with a depth dimension, or the like. In certain embodiments, the x-y coverage resolution describes the surface of the inspection surface as traversed by the inspection robot, which may be two dimensional, conceptually two dimensional with aspects have a three-dimensional component, and/or three dimensional. The description of horizontal and vertical as related to the direction of travel is a non- limiting example, and the inspection surface may have a first conceptualization of the surface (e.g., x-y in a direction unrelated to the traversal direction of the inspection robot), where the inspection robot traverses the inspection surface in a second conceptualization of the surface (e.g., x-y axes oriented in a different manner than the x-y directions of the first conceptualization), where the operations of the inspection robot 16140 such as movement paths and/or sensor inspection locations performed in the second conceptualization are transformed and tracked in the first conceptualization (e.g., by the inspection map configuration circuit 16132, a controller on the inspection robot, a controller on a base station, etc.) to ensure that the desired inspection coverage from the view of the first conceptualization are achieved. Accordingly, the user response command 16122 and communications to the user device 16124 can be operated in the first conceptualization or the second conceptualization according to the preferences of the user, an administrator for the system, the operator, or the like.

[00422] While the first conceptualization and the second conceptualization are described in relation to a two-dimensional description of the inspection surface for clarity of the present description, either or both of the first conceptualization and the second conceptualization may include three- dimensional components and/or may be three-dimensional descriptions of the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the first conceptualization and the second conceptualization may be the same and/or overlay each other (e.g., where the traversal axes of the robot define the view of the inspection surface, and/or where the axes of the inspection surface view and the traversal axes of the robot coincide).

[00423] While the first conceptualization and the second conceptualization are described in terms of the inspection robot traversal and the user device 16124, additional or alternative conceptualizations are possible, such as in terms of an operator view of the inspection surface, other users of the inspection surface, and/or analysis of the inspection surface (e.g., where aligning one axis with a true vertical of the inspection surface, aligning an axis with a temperature gradient of the inspection surface, or other arrangement may provide a desirable feature for the conceptualization for some purpose of the particular system).

[00424] In certain embodiments, the user may provide a desired conceptualization (e.g., orientation of x-y axes, etc.) as a user response command 16122, and/or as any other user interaction as set forth throughout the present disclosure, allowing for the user to interface with depictions of the inspection surface in any desired manner. It can be seen that the utilization of one or more conceptualizations of the inspection surface provide for simplification of certain operations of aspects of systems, procedures, and/or controllers throughout the present disclosure (e.g., user interfaces, operator interfaces, inspection robot movement controls, etc.). It can be seen that the utilization of one or more conceptualizations of the inspection surface allow for combined conceptualizations that have distinct dimensionality, such as two-dimensional for a first conceptualization (e.g., traversal commands and/or sensor distributions for an inspection robot operating on a curved surface such as a tank interior, where the curved surface includes a related three-dimensional conceptualization; and/or where a first conceptualization eliminates the need for a dimension, such as by aligning an axis perpendicular to a cylindrical inspection surface), and a either three-dimensional or a non-simple transformation to a different two-dimensional for a second conceptualization (e.g., a conceptualization having an off-perpendicular axis for a cylindrical inspection surface, where a progression of that axis along the inspection surface would be helical, leading to either a three dimensional conceptualization, or a complex transformed two dimensional conceptualization).

[00425] Referencing FIG. 55, an example procedure for rapid reconfiguration of an inspection robot is depicted. The example procedure includes an operation 16202 to interrogate an inspection surface with a number of sensors, an operation 16204 to interpret inspection base data from the sensors, and an operation 16206 to determine refined inspection data in response to the inspection base data. The example procedure further includes an operation 16208 to determine an inspection response value during the interrogating. The example operation 16208 may additionally or alternatively determine the response value during a period of time that corresponds to a rapid response time. The example procedure further includes an operation 16224 to determine an inspection command value in response to the inspection response value.

[00426] The example procedure may further include an operation 16210 to provide the refined inspection data to a user device, remove server or service, and/or to an operator device, an operation 16212 to receive a user response command from the user device, remove server or service, and/or the operator device, and an operation 16214 to determine the inspection response value further in response to the user response command. [00427] The example procedure may further include an operation 16216 to update an inspection map in response to the inspection command value. The example procedure may further include an operation 16218 to provide a reconfiguration command, and/or an operation 16220 to update a travel path of the inspection robot, in response to the inspection command value. The example procedure may further include an operation 16222 to update an x-y coverage resolution of the inspection robot in response to the inspection command value. In certain embodiments, the operation 16220 includes providing an updated inspection map for operation 16216, and/or providing an updated travel path for operation 16220. In certain embodiments, operation 16222 includes an operation to update coverage resolution of the inspection robot in response to the inspection command value, where the updated coverage resolution corresponds to a selected conceptualization of the inspection surface. [00428] Referencing FIG. 56, an example inspection robot 16302 is depicted, with the inspection robot 16302 operable to perform rapid response configuration and/or reconfiguration for inspection operations of an inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the example inspection robot 16302 is compatible to interact with a controller is configured to perform operations for rapid response to inspection data (e.g., reference FIG. 56 and the related description), and/or may include portions or all of such a controller. Rapid response configuration and/or reconfiguration inspection operations include, without limitation, configuration and/or reconfiguration operations performed during an inspection operation, and/or performed during a period of time that corresponds to a rapid response time. An example inspection robot 16302 may additionally or alternatively include any components, features, and/or aspects of embodiments for an inspection robot as set forth throughout the present disclosure.

[00429] The example inspection robot 16302 includes an inspection chassis 16304 having a number of inspection sensors 16306 configured to interrogate an inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the inspection chassis 16304 corresponds to an inspection robot body, a center chassis, a robot chassis, and/or other similar terminology as utilized throughout the present disclosure. In certain embodiments, the inspection chassis 16304 further includes a pay load, for example a payload coupled to the inspection robot body, and having at least some of the inspection sensors 16306 coupled thereto. Any example payloads and/or inspection sensors and coupling arrangements set forth throughout the present disclosure are contemplated herein.

[00430] The example inspection robot 16302 further includes a drive module 16308 coupled to the inspection chassis 16304, for example a drive module 16308 including one or more wheels, and power, mechanical, and/or communication interfaces to the inspection chassis 16304. The example drive module 16308 is structured to drive the inspection robot over the inspection surface, for example by powering at least one wheel of the drive module 16308, thereby propelling the inspection robot 16302 relative to the inspection surface.

[00431] The example inspection robot 16302 includes a controller 16310 having a number of circuits configured to functionally execute operations of the controller 16310. The arrangement depicted in FIG. 56 is a non-limiting example for clarity of description, and the arrangement of the controller 16310 and/or circuits thereof may vary, for example with the controller 16310 and/or portions thereof positioned on the inspection chassis 16304 and/or other components of the inspection robot 16302, and/or portions of the controller 16310 positioned on a base station, operator computing device, user computing device, remote server, and/or other locations within a system including the inspection robot 16302. The example controller 16310 includes an inspection data circuit 16312 that interprets inspection base data 16314 including data provided by the inspection sensors 16306, and an inspection processing circuit 16316 that determines refined inspection data 16318 in response to the inspection base data 16314. The example controller 16310 includes an inspection configuration circuit 16320 that determines an inspection response value 16322 in response to the refined inspection data, and an inspection response circuit 16324 that provides an inspection command value 16326 in response to the inspection response value 16322. In certain embodiments, the inspection response circuit 16324 provides the inspection command value 16326 during the inspection operations of the inspection robot 16302, and/or during a period of time that corresponds to a rapid response time. In certain embodiments, the inspection response value 16322 and/or the inspection command value 16326 may be determined in whole or part on a controller (e.g., controller 16102, reference FIG. 54) and received by the inspection configuration circuit 16320 and/or inspection response circuit 16324 for utilization by the controller 16310 to perform configuration and/or reconfiguration operations. In certain embodiments, the inspection configuration circuit 16320 and/or inspection response circuit 16324 determine relevant portions of the received inspection response value 16322 and/or the inspection command value 16326 for operations of the inspection robot 16302, and provide the relevant portions of inspection response value 16322 and/or the inspection command value 16326 as response and/or command instructions for the inspection robot 16302 and/or relevant components of the inspection robot 16302.

[00432] The example controller 16310 includes an inspection map configuration circuit 16328 that updates an inspection map 16330 in response to the inspection command value 16326. An example controller 16310 further includes a payload configuration circuit 16332 that provides a reconfiguration command 16334 in response to the inspection command value 16326. In certain embodiments, the payload configuration circuit may additionally or alternatively be referenced as a payload reconfiguration circuit and/or a sensor reconfiguration circuit, as operations of the payload configuration circuit 16332 may adjust, readjust, and/or reconfigure the payload and/or inspection sensors coupled to the payload. Example and non-limiting reconfiguration commands 16334 include a sensor spacing (e.g., horizontal and/or vertical sensor spacing), a couplant flow (e.g., flow rate and/or flow response characteristics such as re-coupling flow responses), a change in an inspection sensor (e.g., activating or de-activating a sensor, data collection from the sensor, and/or determination of inspection base data and/or refined data from the sensor; a change in a scale, sensed resolution, and/or calibrations for a sensor; and/or a change in a sampling rate of the sensor), and/or a force on an inspection sensor (e.g., an active or passive down force, and/or a change in operations of a biasing member and/or an actuator of a payload, arm, and/or sled associated with the inspection sensor). An example inspection robot 16302 is structured to re-traverse a portion of the inspection surface, and/or update an x-y coverage of the inspection operation, for example in response to an update of the inspection map 16330.

[00433] An example inspection robot 16302 includes a trailing payload 16338 structured to perform an operation on the inspection surface, such as altering the inspection surface, in response to the inspection command value 16326. The trailing payload 16338 may be coupled to a rear portion of the inspection chassis 16304. An example inspection robot 16302 includes a payload operation circuit 16336 that selectively operates the trailing pay load 16338 in response to the inspection command value 16326, wherein the inspection command value 16326 includes a command for an operation such as a repair of the inspection surface, painting the inspection surface, welding the inspection surface, and/or applying a visible mark to the inspection surface. An example inspection command value 16326 may additionally or alternatively include a command for an operation such as a cleaning operation for the inspection surface, application of a coating and/or material addition to the inspection surface, and/or applying a selectively visible mark to the inspection surface. An example inspection robot 16302 is further configure to send an alarm and/or a notification to a user device in response to the inspection response value 16322, for example to notify the user and/or an operator that an off-nominal condition has been detected, that a configuration change to the inspection robot 16302 has been performed, and/or that a configuration change is unavailable and/or unsuccessful in whole or part. In certain embodiments, an alert and/or a notification to the user may be performed via a communication to an external controller (e.g., controller 16102 in FIG. 54), and/or the alert and/or notification may be provided by any applicable circuit of the controller 16310. [00434] Referencing FIG. 78, an example system for providing real-time processed inspection data to a user is depicted. The example system includes an inspection robot 100 positioned on an inspection surface 500. The example inspection robot 100 includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example system depicted in FIG. 78. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 may have one or more payloads, and may include one or more sensors on each payload.

[00435] The example inspection robot 100 includes a number of sensors 2202, where the operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these.

[00436] The example system further includes a controller 21002 having a number of circuits configured to functionally perform operations of the controller 21002. The example system includes the controller 21002 having an inspection data circuit that interprets inspection base data from the sensors 2202, an inspection processing circuit that determines refined inspection data in response to the inspection base data, and a user interface circuit that provides the refined inspection data to a user interface device 21006. The user interface circuit further communicates with the user interface device 21006, for example to interpret a user request value such as a request to change a display value, to change inspection parameters, and/or to perform marking, cleaning, and/or repair operations related to the inspection surface 500. The example controller 21002 may additionally or alternatively include aspects of any controller, circuit, or similar device as described throughout the present disclosure. Aspects of example circuits may be embodied as one or more computing devices, computer-readable instructions configured to perform one or more operations of a circuit upon execution by a processor, one or more sensors, one or more actuators, and/or communications infrastructure (e.g., routers, servers, network infrastructure, or the like). Further details of the operations of certain circuits associated with the controller 21002 are set forth, without limitation, in the portion of the disclosure referencing FIG. 79. [00437] The example controller 21002 is depicted schematically as a single device for clarity of description, but the controller 21002 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or may include portions at least partially positioned with other devices in the system (e.g., on the inspection robot 100, or the user interface device 21006). In certain embodiments, the controller 21002 may be at least partially positioned on a computing device associated with an operator of the inspection (not shown), such as a local computer at a facility including the inspection surface 500, a laptop, and/or a mobile device. In certain embodiments, the controller 21002 may alternatively or additionally be at least partially positioned on a computing device that is remote to the inspection operations, such as on a web-based computing device, a cloud computing device, a communicatively coupled device, or the like.

[00438] In certain embodiments, the controller 21002 communicates to the user interface device 21006 using an intermediate structure 21004, such as a web portal, mobile application service, network connection, or the like. In certain embodiments, the intermediate structure 21004 may be varied by the controller 21002 and/or a user 21008, for example allowing the user 21008 to connect to the controller 21002 using a web portal at one time, and a mobile application at a different time. The controller 21002 may include operations such as performing an authentication operation, a login operation, or other confirmation that a user 21008 is authorized to interact with the controller 21002. In certain embodiments, the interactions of the user 21008 may be limited according to permissions related to the user 21008, the user interface device 21006, and/or any other considerations (e.g., a location of the user, an operating stage of an inspection, a limitation imposed by an operator of the inspection, etc.). In certain embodiments, and/or during certain operating conditions, the controller 21002 communicates directly with the user interface device 21006, and/or the user 21008 may interface directly with a computing device having at least a portion of the controller 21002 positioned thereon.

[00439] The example system further includes the inspection data circuit responsive to the user request value to adjust the interpreted inspection base data and/or the interrogation of the inspection surface. For example, and without limitation, the user request value may provide for a change to an inspection resolution (e.g., a horizontal distance between sensors 2202, a vertical distance at which sensor sampling is performed, selected positions of the inspection surface 500 to be interrogated, etc.), a change to sensor values (e.g., sensor resolution such as dedicated bits for digitization; sensor scaling; sensor communicated data parameters; sensor minimum or maximum values, etc.), a change to the planned location trajectory of the inspection robot (e.g., scheduling additional inspection passes, changing inspected areas, canceling planned inspection portions, adding inspection portions, etc.), and/or a change in sensor types (e.g., adding, removing, or replacing utilized sensors). In certain embodiments, the inspection data circuit responds to the user request value by performing an inspection operation that conforms with the user request value, by adjusting inspection operations to incrementally change the inspection scheme to be closer to the user request value (e.g., where the user request value cannot be met, where other constraints prevent the user request value from being met, and/or where permissions of the user 21008 allow only partial performance of the user request value). In certain embodiments, a difference between the user request value and the adjusted interpreted inspection base data and/or interrogation scheme may be determined, and/or may be communicated to the user, an operator, an administrator, another entity, and/or recorded in association with the data (e.g., as a data field, metadata, label for the data, etc.).

[00440] In certain embodiments, the inspection processing circuit is responsive to the user request value to adjust the determination of the refined inspection data. In certain embodiments, certain sensed values utilize a significant amount of post-processing to determine a data value. For example, a UT sensor may output a number of return times, which may be filtered, compared to thresholds, subjected to frequency analysis, or the like. In certain embodiments, the inspection base data includes information provided by the sensor 2202, and/or information provided by the inspection robot 100 (e.g., using processing capability on the inspection robot 100, hardware filters that act on the sensor 2202 raw data, de-bounced data, etc.). The inspection base data may be raw data - for example, the actual response provided by the sensor such as an electronic value (e.g., a voltage, frequency, or current output), but the inspection base data may also be processed data (e.g., return times, temperature, pressure, etc.). As utilized herein, the refined inspection data is data that is subjected to further processing, generally to yield data that provides a result value of interest (e.g., a thickness, or a state value such as “conforming” or “failed”) or that provides a utilizable input for another model or virtual sensor (e.g., a corrected temperature, corrected flow rate, etc.). Accordingly, the inspection base data includes information from the sensor, and/or processed information from the sensor, while the refined inspection data includes information from the inspection base data that has been subjected to further processing. In certain embodiments, the computing time and/or memory required to determine the refined inspection data can be very significant. In certain embodiments, determination of the refined inspection data can be improved with the availability of significant additional data, such as data from offset and/or related inspections performed in similar systems, calibration options for sensors, and/or correction options for sensors (e.g., based on ambient conditions; available power for the sensor; materials of the inspection surface, coatings, or the like; etc.). Accordingly, in previously known systems, the availability of refined inspection data was dependent upon the meeting of the inspection base data with significant computing resources (including processing, memory, and access to databases), introducing significant delays (e.g., downloading data from the inspection robot 100 after an inspection is completed) and/or costs (e.g., highly capable computing devices on the inspection robot 100 and/or carried by an inspection operator) before the refined inspection data is available for analysis. Further, previously known systems do not allow for the utilization of refined inspection data during inspection operations (e.g., making an adjustment before the inspection operation is complete) and/or utilization by a customer of the data (e.g., a user 21008) that may have a better understanding of the commercial considerations of the inspection output than an inspection operator.

[00441] Referencing FIG. 79, an example controller 21002 is depicted. The example controller 21002 is consistent with a controller usable in a system, for example the system depicted in FIG. 78, although the controller 21002 and/or aspects thereof may be usable in any system and/or with any embodiments set forth in the present disclosure.

[00442] The example controller 21002 includes an inspection data circuit 21102. The example inspection data circuit 21102 interprets inspection base data 21122, including data provided by an inspection robot 100 interrogating an inspection surface 500 with a number of inspection sensors 2202. The example controller 21002 further includes an inspection processing circuit 21104 that determines refined inspection data 21110 in response to the inspection base data 21122.

[00443] The example controller further includes a user interface circuit 21106 the provides the refined inspection data 21110 to a user interface device. In certain embodiments, the refined inspection data 21110 includes and/or is utilized to generate depictions of inspection results, including with quantified and/or qualitative values of the inspection results, such as wall thicknesses, coating thicknesses, compliant or non-compliant areas, service life descriptions (e.g., time remaining until service is required, service cost or amortization values, etc.), and/or any other values of interest determinable from the refined inspection data 21110. In certain embodiments, the refined inspection data 21110 may additionally or alternatively include data quality descriptions, such as confidence values, missing data descriptions, and/or sensing or data processing quality descriptions. In certain embodiments, the user interface circuit 21106 may be configured to adjust the displayed data, the display type, and/or provide a selection interface allowing a user to choose from among available data displays. The example user interface circuit 21106 further interprets a user request value 21124, and determines an inspection command value 21112 in response to the user request value 21124. In certain embodiments, the controller 21002 may be configured to utilize the user request value 21124 directly, where the user interface circuit 21106 accordingly passes the user request value 21124 to other aspects of the controller 21002 as the inspection command value 21112. In certain embodiments, the user interface circuit 21106 determines which aspects of the controller 21002 will be responsive to the user request value 21124, and determines one or more inspection command values 21112 to pass to the respective aspects of the controller 21002 to be responsive to the user request value 21124. For example, a user request value 21124 to inspect certain areas of the inspection surface 500, to change a planned position trajectory of the inspection robot 100, or the like, may be passed as inspection adjustments 21116 by an inspection configuration circuit 21108 to make appropriate adjustments to the inspection operations of the inspection robot 100 (e.g., utilizing command to the inspection robot 100, to an operator of the inspection robot 100, changing a planned path data structure, or the like). The example controller 21002 further includes the inspection configuration circuit 21108 that provides the inspection command value(s) 21112 to the inspection robot 100 (and/or to other aspects of the system) during the interrogating of the inspection surface 500 (e.g., while the inspection is occurring, and/or before the inspection is considered to be complete).

[00444] An example embodiment includes the inspection command value 21112 including a command to adjust in inspection operation (e.g., inspection adjustment 21116) of the inspection robot 100. Example and non-limiting inspection adjustments 21116 include adjusting an inspection location trajectory of the inspection robot (e.g., the region of the inspection surface to be inspected, the inspection pathing on the inspection surface, and/or the spatial order of inspection of the inspection surface), adjusting a calibration value of one of the inspection sensors (e.g., A/D conversion values, UT calibrations and/or assumptions utilized to process signals, and/or other parameters utilized to operate sensors, interpret data, and/or post-process data from sensors), and/or a command to enable at least one additional inspection sensor (e.g., activating an additional sensor, receiving data provided by the sensor, and/or storing data provided by the sensor). In certain embodiments, the at least one additional inspection sensor is a sensor having a different type of sensing relative to a previously operating sensor, and/or a sensor having a different capability and/or different position on the inspection robot (e.g., positioned on a different payload, different sled, and/or at a different position on a sled). An example inspection adjustment 21116 command includes a command to enable at least one additional inspection operation, where the inspection processing circuit 21104 determines the refined inspection data 21110 in response to the at least one additional inspection operation. Example and non- limiting additional inspection operations include reinspecting at least portion of the inspection surface, performing an inspection with a sensor having distinct capabilities, sensing type, and/or calibrations relative to a previously operating sensor, inspecting additional regions of the inspection surface beyond an initially planned region, changing an inspection resolution (e.g., a spacing between sensed locations), changing a traversal speed of the inspection robot during inspection operations, or the like. [00445] An example inspection command value 21112 includes a command to perform a repair operation 21118 of the inspection surface, such as a welding operation, applying a coating, a painting operation, a cleaning operation 21120, and/or applying an additive operation (e.g., adding substrate material, a coating material, a marking material, and/or a paint) to at least a portion of the inspection surface. An example inspection command value 21112 includes an operation to perform a marking operation 21114 on the inspection surface. Example and non- limiting marking operations include applying a visible mark, applying a selectively visible mark (e.g., a material visible under certain conditions such as in the presence of a UV light), and/or an operation to apply a virtual mark to at least a portion of the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, the marking operation 21114 additionally includes performing operations such as cleaning, repairing, and/or collecting additional data in relation to the portion of the inspection surface to be marked. In certain embodiments, a marking operation includes mitigation operations (e.g., to extend a service time, allow a facility to continue operations, and/or provide time to allow for additional inspections or subsequent service or repair to be performed), inspection operations (e.g., gathering more detailed information, confirming information, imaging information, etc. related to the marked region), and/or cleaning operations (e.g., to ensure that data collection is reliable, to ensure that a mark adheres and/or can be seen, and/or to enhance related imaging information) for the marked region of the inspection surface and/or adjacent regions.

[00446] An example inspection command value 21112 includes a command to capture a visual representation of at least a portion of the inspection surface, such as an image, a series of images, and/or video images, of the area to be marked, adjacent areas, and/or perspective views (e.g., to provide context, allow for easier location of the marked area, etc.) of related to the region of the inspection surface to be marked.

[00447] An example inspection command value 21112 includes a display threshold adjustment value, such as a threshold utilized to label, categorize, colorize, or otherwise depict aspects of the inspection data on a visual representation of at least a portion of the inspection surface. In certain embodiments, user interface outputs 21126 such as the display threshold adjustment value may be determined in response to the inspection data (e.g., to show anomalous regions based on the inspection data values, based on averages, quartiles, or other statistical determinations, etc.), in response to user request values 21124 received from a user interface provided to a user device, and/or in response to operator commands (e.g., from an operator interacting with a base station, local computing device, mobile computing device, dedicated device communicatively coupled to the inspection robot, etc.). [00448] In certain embodiments, a user device and/or user interface device includes a computing device communicative coupled to the controller 21002. Communicative coupling may be provided through a local area network (e.g., a facility network where the facility includes the inspection surface), a wide area network, the internet, a web application, a mobile application, and/or combinations of these. Example and non-limiting user interface devices include a laptop, a desktop, or a mobile computing device such as a smart phone or tablet. In certain embodiments, the user interface device is positioned at a separate physical location from the inspection surface (e.g., at another location in a facility including the inspection surface, and/or away from the facility).

[00449] In certain embodiments, the inspection command value 21112 includes a display threshold adjustment value, where the inspection processing circuit 21104 updates the refined inspection data 21110 in response to the display threshold adjustment value (e.g., changing a sensor, sensor parameter, inspection path, etc. to provide data sufficient to support the display threshold adjustment value; adjusting post-processing of inspection data in response to the display threshold adjustment value, such as determining anomalous data, enhancing or adjusting a resolution of the refined data, and/or providing additional related data to data corresponding to the display threshold being adjusted).

[00450] In certain embodiments, the inspection-based data includes raw sensor data, and/or minimally processed data. In certain embodiments, the inspection based data includes ultra-sonic (UT) sensor data, which may additionally or alternatively include sensor calibrations such as settings and assumptions utilized to determine a processed parameter (e.g., a wall thickness of the inspection surface, a presence of a crack or anomaly, and/or a thickness of a coating and/or debris). The sensor calibrations and/or other descriptive data (e.g., time stamps, location data, facility data, etc.) may be stored as metadata with the raw sensor data, and/or related to the raw sensor data such that a device accessing the raw sensor data can additionally request or retrieve the metadata. The present description references UT sensor data and related data, but sensor calibrations, related data, and/or metadata may be stored in relation to any type of raw sensor data and/or minimally processed data.

[00451] Referencing FIGS. 80-84, an example procedure for adjusting an inspection operation in response to a user request value is depicted. The example procedure includes an operation 21202 to provide inspection traversal commands (e.g., a description of regions of an inspection surface to be inspected, a pathing description for an inspection robot, etc.), an operation 21204 to provide interrogation commands to a number of inspection sensors of the inspection robot, an operation 21206 to interpret inspection base data from the inspection sensors (e.g., raw sensor data, minimally processed sensor data, and/or sensor calibration or other metadata), an 21208 to determine refined inspection data in response to the inspection base data, an operation 21210 to operate a user interface accessible to a user interface device, and to provide the refined inspection data to the user interface. For example, the refined inspection data may include processed data values (e.g., thickness values, wear values, temperatures, coating indications, service life and/or service date values, etc.), which may be presented as tables, graphs, visual depictions of the inspection surface, or the like. In certain embodiments, refined inspection data may include raw sensor data and/or minimally processed sensor data, and/or may further include associated calibrations or other metadata, for example to allow the user to evaluate the processing and determine whether sensor data processing parameters should be updated or adjusted, perform sensitivity analysis with respect to processing calibrations and/or assumptions, etc. In certain embodiments, operation 21210 to operate the user interface includes operating a web portal, web site, mobile application, proprietary application, and/or a database accessible with an application programming interface (API), and interacting with a user device through any of the foregoing.

[00452] The example procedure further includes an operation to interpret a user request value 21212, for example a request to adjust a display (e.g., displayed data, thresholds, virtual marks, displayed region of the inspection surface, etc.) presented on the user interface, a request to adjust any aspect of the inspection operation (e.g., sensors utilized and/or calibrations for the sensors; sensor positions on one or more pay loads; sampling rates; robot traversal trajectory including locations to be inspected, traversal speed, areas to be re-inspected, imaged, and/or inspected with an additional inspection operations; authorizations for additional time, cost, utilization of certain operations such as welding, repair, or utilization of certain materials; adjusting downforce parameters for the inspection robot; adjusting thresholds for any operations described throughout the present disclosure, such as thresholds to enable additional or alternative inspection operations or sensors, thresholds to display information on an inspection display, thresholds to perform operations such as repair, marking, and/or cleaning and an operation, and/or thresholds to respond to off- nominal conditions such as couplant loss events, obstacle detection events, sensor evaluation, processing, or scoring values such as primary mode scores and/or secondary mode scores). The example procedure includes an operation 21214 to adjust the inspection operation in response to the user request value. One or more of any adjustments to the inspection robot and/or inspection operations as set forth throughout the present disclosure may be implemented for operation 21214. [00453] An example procedure includes adjusting the inspection operation by adjusting the inspection operation to achieve the implied conditions from the user request value, but adjusting the inspection operation may additionally or alternatively include one or more of: adjusting the inspection operation to comply with a portion of the user request value; considering the user request value adjustments (e.g., as part of a prioritization of one or more additional requests), where the user request value adjustments may not be implemented, implemented only in part, or implemented in whole; storing a description of adjustments of the inspection operation for implementation at a later time (e.g., later in the present inspection operation, and/or in a subsequent inspection operation); implementing one or more adjustments for which a user providing the user request value has authorization, and/or not implementing one or more adjustments for which the user providing the user request value does not have authorization; and/or preserving a capability to implement one or more adjustments for which the user providing the user request value does not have authorization and/or pending an authorization of the user (e.g., performing additional inspection operations to take additional data responsive to the user request value, but preventing access of the user to the additional data until the user is authorized to access the data, and/or until user authorization for the additional data is confirmed). In certain embodiments, the operation 21214 further includes providing an alert and/or notification to the user, user device, and/or user interface in response to a partial implementation and/or non-implementation of the adjustments. The alert and/or notification may include an indication that the adjustments were not performed, a description of which aspects of the adjustments were not performed, and indication of why no adjustments or incomplete adjustments were performed (e.g., indicating a higher priority request, system capability that is lacking, that the user requires authorization, etc.). In certain embodiments, the operation 21214 includes providing an alert and/or notification to an administrator, supervisor, super-user, and/or operator of the inspection robot, indicating that a user request value was received, and/or indicating whether the user request value was addressed in full or part. In certain embodiments, the operation 21214 further includes providing an authorization request to an administrator, supervisor, super-user, and/or operator of the inspection robot for the user in response to the user request value. The described example operations are non- limiting, and set forth to provide illustrations of certain capabilities of embodiments herein.

[00454] An example user request value includes an inspection command value, where the operation 21302 includes adjusting inspection traversal commands and/or the interrogation commands in response to the inspection command value. An example operation 21302 includes adjusting inspection traversal commands to adjust an inspection location trajectory (e.g., position trajectory) of the inspection robot, adjusting the interrogation command to adjust calibration value(s) for one or more inspection sensors, and/or adjusting the interrogation commands to enable one or more additional sensors. An example operation 21414 includes enabling at least one additional inspection operation in response to a user request value (e.g., as a repair command value). An example user request value includes a repair command value, and operation 21512 includes providing a repair operation command. In certain embodiments, the repair command provides a coating application command, a painting operation command, a cleaning operation command, and/or an additive operation command. An example user request value includes a weld command value, and operation 21513 includes providing a welding operation command.

[00455] An example user request value includes a marking command value, and operation 21702 includes providing a marking operation command. In certain embodiments, the marking operation command includes a visible marking command, a selectively visible marking command, and/or a virtual marking command. In certain embodiments, operation 21210 to operate the user interface, and/or operation 21214 to adjust an inspection operation, include selectively providing a virtual mark 21706 to the user interface (e.g., showing virtual marks in a display layer 21704 of the user interface, showing virtual marks upon request by the user, showing virtual marks according to a mark type requested by the user, showing virtual marks in response to an authorization of the user, etc.).

[00456] An example user request value includes a visual capture command value, where operation 21214 includes providing a visual capture operation command in response to the visual capture command value (e.g., where a camera, optical sensor, or other device of the inspection robot is responsive to the visual capture operation command to capture associated visual data from the inspection surface).

[00457] Turning now to FIG. 75, an example system and/or apparatus for inspecting and/or repairing an inspection surface 500 (e.g., reference FIG. 2) with an inspection robot 100 (e.g., reference FIG. 1) is depicted. The example inspection robot 100 includes any inspection robot having a number of sensors 2202 associated therewith and configured to inspect a selected area. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection robot 100 as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example system depicted in FIG. 75. In certain embodiments, the inspection robot 100 may have one or more payloads 2 (e.g., reference FIG. 1) and may include one or more sensors 2202 on each pay load 2.

[00458] Operations of the inspection robot 100 provide the sensors 2202 in proximity to selected locations of the inspection surface 500 and collect associated data, thereby interrogating the inspection surface 500. Interrogating, as utilized herein, includes any operations to collect data associated with a given sensor, to perform data collection associated with a given sensor (e.g., commanding sensors, receiving data values from the sensors, or the like), and/or to determine data in response to information provided by a sensor (e.g., determining values, based on a model, from sensor data; converting sensor data to a value based on a calibration of the sensor reading to the corresponding data; and/or combining data from one or more sensors or other information to determine a value of interest). A sensor 2202 may be any type of sensor as set forth throughout the present disclosure, but includes at least a UT sensor, an EMI sensor (e.g., magnetic induction or the like), a temperature sensor, a pressure sensor, an optical sensor (e.g., infrared, visual spectrum, and/or ultra-violet), a visual sensor (e.g., a camera, pixel grid, or the like), or combinations of these. [00459] The example system may include the inspection robot 100 and/or a controller 802 as shown in FIG. 75. The controller 802 may have a number of circuits configured to functionally perform operations of the controller 802. For example, the controller 802 may have an inspection circuit 18102, an inspection visualization circuit 18106, a user interaction circuit 18110, an action request circuit 18114, and/or an event processing circuit 18118. In embodiments, the controller 802 may have, in place of or in addition to any of the preceding circuits, a repair circuit 18122 and/or marking circuit 18124. The example controller 802 may additionally or alternatively include aspects of any controller, circuit, or similar device as described throughout the present disclosure. Aspects of example circuits may be embodied as one or more computing devices, computer-readable instructions configured to perform one or more operations of a circuit upon execution by a processor, one or more sensors, one or more actuators, and/or communications infrastructure (e.g., routers, servers, network infrastructure, or the like). Further details of the operations of certain circuits associated with the controller 802 are set forth, without limitation, in the portion of the disclosure referencing FIGS. 75-77.

[00460] The example controller 802 is depicted schematically as a single device for clarity of description, but the controller 802 may be a single device, a distributed device, and/or may include portions at least partially positioned with other devices in the system (e.g., on the inspection robot 100). In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may be at least partially positioned on a computing device associated with an operator of the inspection (not shown), such as a local computer at a facility including the inspection surface 500, a laptop, and/or a mobile device. In certain embodiments, the controller 802 may alternatively or additionally be at least partially positioned on a computing device that is remote to the inspection operations, such as on a web-based computing device, a cloud computing device, a communicatively coupled device, or the like.

[00461] Accordingly, as illustrated in FIG. 77, the inspection circuit 18102 commands operations of the inspection robot 100 operating on the inspection surface 500 and interprets inspection data 18104 from one or more sensors 2202 operationally coupled to the inspection robot 100. The inspection data 18104 may include information representative of a status and/or characteristic of the inspection surface, e.g., a thickness, coating coverage, stress and/or any other type of property of the inspection surface. The inspection data 18104 may include still images and/or video images of the inspection surface 500 and/or of an obstacle encountered by the inspection robot 100. The inspection data 18104 may be an image of a structural deficiency, e.g., a crack, bump, recess, etc., in the inspection surface 500. In embodiments, the inspection data 18104 may include electromagnetic, ultrasonic and/or other types of information collected from the inspection surface 500 by the sensors 2202. [00462] The inspection visualization circuit 18106 may generate an inspection map 18108 in response to the inspection data 18104. Without limitation to any other aspect of the present disclosure, an inspection map as set forth throughout the present disclosure, including any features or characteristics thereof, is contemplated for the example inspection map 18108 depicted in FIG. 77. For example, As disclosed herein, the inspection map 18108 may depict a layout of the inspection surface 500 along with one or more characteristics of the surface 500, obstacles on the surface 500 and/or other features such as markings.

[00463] The user interaction circuit 18110 may provide the inspection map 18108 to a user/operator device (e.g., reference FIG. 74 and the related description) for display to a user and/or operator of the inspection robot 100. Such a devices may include, but are not limited to, laptops, smart phones, tablets, desktop computers and/or other types of devices that provide for interactive graphical user interfaces. The user interaction circuit 18110 may interpret a user focus value 18112 from the user device. In embodiments, the user interaction circuit 18110 interprets the user focus value 18112 by interrogating a display of the user device. For example, the user focus value 18112 may include event type data 18204 corresponding to one or more user interactive events within the interactive graphical user interface presented on the user device. Such events may include, but are not limited to: mouse position 18206, menu-selections 18208, touch screen indications 18210, keys strokes 18212 and/or virtual gestures 18214. The user focus value 18112 may be generated by the user device in response to a user interactive event corresponding to a display of the inspection map 18108 within the graphical user interface on the user device. For example, in embodiments, the inspection map 18108 may depict an anomaly in a characteristic of the inspection surface 500, e.g., a portion of the surface 500 that is thinner than an expected value. The user and/or operator may then generate the user focus value 18112 by clicking on the anomaly in the inspection map 18108 as shown on the user device.

[00464] The action request circuit 18114 may determine an action 18116 for the inspection robot 100 in response to the user focus value 18112, and the event processing circuit 18118 may provide an action command value 18120 in response to the determined action 18116. The inspection circuit 18102 may also update the operations of the inspection robot 100 in response to the action command value 18120.

[00465] As illustrated in FIG. 75, the action command value 18120 may include location data 18216 identifying a location at which the action 18116 is to be performed. As such, in embodiments, the action request circuit 18114 may determine the location data 18216 based on the user focus value 18112. For example, a user may click and/or select a location within the inspection map 18108 displayed in the user interface on the user device. The coordinate information 18202 of the inspection surface 500 corresponding to the location selected by the user may then be included in the user focus value 18112. Thus, in embodiments, clicking a location in the inspection map 18108 may direct the inspection robot 100 to the corresponding location on the inspection surface 500 for the purpose of performing an action 18116 at that location. In embodiments, the location data 18216 may be in real space and/or a virtual space.

[00466] In embodiments, the action command value 18120 may correspond to a repair procedure, and the repair circuit may, in response to the action command value 18120, may execute the repair procedure. The repair procedure may include actuating: a welding device; a drilling device; a sawing device; an ablation device; and/or a heating device. For example, a user may select an identified crack on the inspection map 18108 and then further select an option within the graphical user interface to repair the object, and further select the type of repair, e.g., weld, to perform on the crack. As will be understood, embodiments of the inspection map 18108 and/or graphical user interface may provide for the identification and repair of other types of anomalies in the inspection surface 500. In embodiments, the controller 802 may direct the inspection robot 100 to repair anomalies as they are encountered and identified by the controller 802. In other words, some embodiment of the controller 802 may automatically repair anomalies and/or obstacles on the inspection surface 500. [00467] In embodiments, the action command value 18120 may correspond to a marking procedure and the marking circuit 18124, in response to the action command value 18120, may execute the marking procedure by actuating: a painting device; a stamping device; a drilling device; a sawing device; an ablation device; and/or a heating device. For example, the graphical user interface may provide for the user to mark areas and/or object of interest shown in the inspection map 18108, with the inspection robot 100 physically marking the actual location on the inspection surface 500 corresponding to the location of the area and/or object of interest in the inspection map 18108. For example, a user may notice an area of the inspection map 18108 depicting a thinner than expected regions of the inspection surface 500. The user may then select an option in the graphical user interface that to mark the location in the inspection map 18108 with a marker, which in turn, instructs the inspection robot 100 to make a physical mark at the actual location on the inspection surface 500 corresponding to the marked location in the inspection map 18108. In embodiments, the controller 802 may direct the inspection robot 100 to mark anomalies and/or obstacles as they are encountered and identified by the controller 802. In other words, some embodiment of the controller 802 may automatically mark anomalies and/or obstacles on the inspection surface 500. [00468] In embodiments, the action command value 18120 may correspond to an inspection procedure and the inspection circuit, in response to the action command value 18120, may execute the inspection procedure by actuating a sensor 2202. For example, in embodiments, a user may identify a region of the inspection map 18108 that the user may wish to have re- inspected with a higher resolution sensor and/or a different type of sensor. The user may then define the boundaries of the region within the graphical user interface on the inspection map 18108, which in turn, causes the inspection robot 100 to reinspect the actual region on the inspection surface within the boundaries defined in the graphical user interface. In embodiments, the graphical user interface may further provide for a user to define multiple regions within the inspection map and assign distinct payloads to be used by the inspection robot 100 in each of the defined regions. In embodiments, the controller 802 may direct the inspection robot 100 to re-inspect anomalies as they are encountered and identified by the controller 802. In other words, some embodiment of the controller 802 may automatically re-inspect anomalies and/or obstacles on the inspection surface 500.

[00469] As will be further appreciated, in embodiments, the event processing circuit 18118 may provide the action command value 18120 during a run-time/inspection run of the inspection robot 100. As will be appreciated, providing for run-time updates reduces the amount of time to for rechecking, repairing and/or marking areas of the inspection surface 500. In other words, a user/operator of the inspection robot 100 need not wait until the inspection robot 100 has finished an inspection run before the inspection robot can address an issue/abnormality that was discovered during the inspection run.

[00470] Turning to FIG. 77, a method for inspecting and/or repairing an inspection surface 500 is shown. The method may include generating 18302 an inspection map 18108 in response to inspection data 18104 and providing 18350 the inspection map 18108 on a user display. The method may include interpreting 18304 a user focus value 18112, determining 18308 an action in response to the user focus value 18112, and/or providing 18312 an action command value 18120 in response to the determined action 18116. Interpreting 18304 a user focus value 18112 may include interrogating 18306 the user display. In embodiments, the method may further include identifying and/or determining 18310 a location value at which the determined action 18116 is to be performed. In embodiments, determining 18310 the location value may be based in part on the user focus value 18112. In embodiments, determining 18310 the location value may be based in part on coordinate information 18202 in the user focus value 18112 from the inspection map 18108. The location value may be in real space or virtual space. The user focus value may include event type data indicating that the user focus value 18112 was generated in response to at least one of: a mouse position; a menu-selection; a touch screen indication; a key stroke; and/or a virtual gesture. [00471] In embodiments, the method may further include executing 18314 a repair procedure corresponding to the action command value 18120. The repair procedure may include minor and/or major repairs. Minor repairs may include items such as fixing hairline cracks and/or patching small holes in the inspection surface 500 which may be completed in a few hours or less. Major repairs may include items such as fixing larger cracks and/or welding patches over holes in the inspection surface which may take more than two (2) hours. The repair procedure may include actuating one or more of a welding device 18316, a drilling device 18318, a sawing device 18320, an ablation device 18322, and/or a heating device 18324. For example, the inspection robot 100 may weld an identified emerging crack in the surface.

[00472] In embodiments, the method may further include executing 18326 a marking procedure corresponding to the action command value 18120. The marking procedure may include actuating a painting device 18328, a stamping device 18330, a sawing device 18334, a drilling device 18332, an ablation device 18336 and/or a heating device 18338. The painting device may be a spray gun, brush, roller and/or other suitable device for painting the inspection surface 500. The stamping device may be a press, die, or other suitable device. The sawing device may be a rotating saw, laser, or other suitable device. The drilling device may be a rotary drill, laser, or other suitable device. The ablation device may be a plasma torch, laser, or other suitable device. The heating device may be an induction heater, an infrared heater, a laser, and/or other suitable device.

[00473] In embodiments, the method may include executing 18340 an inspection procedure corresponding to the action command value 18120. Executing 18340 the inspection procedure may include actuating 18342 an inspection sensor 2202.

[00474] In embodiments, providing 18312 the action command value 18120 may occur during a run-time of the inspection robot 100.

[00475] FIG. 95 is a schematic diagram of an RTS prism in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure.

[00476] With reference to FIG. 92, to provide adequate line-of-sight coverage, a prism configuration that may create a complete coverage map when mounted normal to a surface is provided in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure. Referring to FIG. 92, a RTS prism 224100, in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure, includes seven individual trihedral corner (TC) reflectors, e.g., first to seventh TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112, 224114 that are configured to reflect substantially all light from the center of the RTS prism 224100 (e.g., ±1.5 mm), and a single mounting cap 224116 on a bottom of the RTS prism 224100. In the illustration of FIG. 92, the first TC reflector 224102 is on a left front of the RTS prism 224100; the second TC reflector 224104 is on a right front of the RTS prism 224100; the third TC reflector 224112 is on a front center of the RTS prism 224100; the fourth TC reflector 224108 is on a left rear of the RTS prism 224100; the fifth TC reflector 224110 is on a right rear of the RTS prism 224100; the sixth TC reflector 224106 is on a rear center of the RTS prism 224100; and the seventh TC reflector 224114 is on a top of the RTS prism 224100. The mounting cap 224116 is on only the bottom of the RTS prism 224100, and there is no mounting cap on the top of the RTS prism 224100. Instead, the seventh TC reflector 224114 is on the top of the RTS prism 224100. The RTS prism 224100 may be referred to as a “1.5 plane prism.”

[00477] With further reference to FIG. 92, the RTS prism 224100 may be for reflecting a laser and may include the single mounting cap 224116 at a first end of the RTS prism 224100, and the first to seventh trihedral corner (TC) reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112, 224114, each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector 224114, among the first to seventh TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112, 224114, is on a second end of the RTS prism 224100 opposite to the first end of the RTS prism 224100.

[00478] In the RTS prism 224100, the seventh TC reflector 224114 may have a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap 224116. In the RTS prism 224100, the first to sixth TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112, among the first to seventh TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112, 224114, are arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector 224114 and the mounting cap 224116.

[00479] In the RTS prism 224100, for each of the first to third TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts the top surface of the mounting cap 224116, and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors 224108, 224110, 224112, a first side edge, among the three side edges, directly contacts a side edge of the seventh TC reflector 224114.

[00480] FIG. 93A is a schematic diagram of a 3D line-of-sight coverage area for the RTS prism of FIG. 92. FIG. 93B is a section view of the 3D line-of-sight coverage area of FIG.96.

[00481] Referring to FIG. 93 A, a hemisphere-type shape may provide a reflective orientation coverage (ROC) coverage map 225102 with adequate line-of-sight reflective coverage. To facilitate this reflective coverage, in an embodiment, the seventh TC reflector 224114 is disposed on the top of the RTS prism 224100, as compared to the six TC reflectors of the traditional RTS prism 222100 of FIG. 90. A 1.5 plane prism may create an ROC coverage map 225102 that resembles a modified hemisphere shape. The resultant ROC coverage map 225102 is the sum of a hemisphere with the bottom half of the modified torus shape discussed in the section above. Referring to FIG. 93B, which is a section view of the ROC coverage map 225102 of FIG. 93 A, a line-of-sight coverage is shown in area 225104, and a loss in coverage is depicted in area 225106. There is no line-of-sight coverage below the plane of the mounting cap 224116.

[00482] Referring to FIG. 94, an apparatus 226100, in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure, may include: an inspection robot 226102, e.g., a robot crawler, including: a body 226104, and a prism 226106 for reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head that is at a fixed location, the prism including: a single mounting cap 226108 mounted on the body 226104 of the inspection robot 226102 at a first end of the prism 226106, and first to sixth trihedral comer (TC) reflectors 226110 (e.g., first to sixth TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112 of FIG. 92) and a seventh TC reflector 224114 (e.g., the seventh TC reflector 224114 of FIG. 92), each TC reflector including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector 226112 is on a second end of the prism 226106 opposite to the first end of the prism 226106. The illustrated body 226104 and prism 226106 are not necessarily to scale.

[00483] In the apparatus 226100, the seventh TC reflector 226112 may include a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap 226108. In the apparatus 226100, the first to sixth TC reflectors 226110 may be arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector 226112 and the mounting cap 226108. In the apparatus 226100, for each of the first to third TC reflectors, among the first to sixth TC reflectors 226110 (e.g., first to third TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106 of FIG. 92), a first side edge, among the three side edges, may directly contact the top surface of the mounting cap 226108, and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors, among the first to sixth TC reflectors 226110 (e.g., fourth to sixth TC reflectors 224108, 224110, 224112 of FIG. 92), a first side edge, among the three side edges, may directly contact a side edge of the seventh TC reflector 226112. The relative angles of each surface of the first to sixth TC reflectors 224102, 224104, 224106, 224108, 224110, 224112 with respect to the top surface of the mounting cap 226108 in an embodiment, e.g., as shown in FIG. 94, may be different from the relative angles of each surface of the first to sixth TC reflectors 222102, 222104, 222106, 222108, 222110, 222112 with respect to the top surface of the mounting cap 222114 of the traditional RTS prism 222100 shown in FIG. 90. [00484] Referring to FIG. 95, a method 227100, in accordance with an embodiment of the present disclosure, may include providing a prism reflecting a laser emitted from a laser tracking head (227102), including: providing a single mounting cap mounted on the body of the inspection robot at a first end of the prism (227104), and providing first to seventh trihedral comer (TC) reflectors (227106), each including a reflective surface including: three side edges, and three corners at respective intercept points between the side edges, wherein the seventh TC reflector, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, is on a second end of the prism opposite to the first end of the prism. [00485] Referring to FIG. 96, the method 227100 may further include providing the prism on an inspection robot, the inspection robot including a body to which the mounting cap is mounted (228102). The method 227100 may further include reflecting a laser from the laser tracking head on at least the seventh TC reflector (228104). The method 227100 may further include further reflecting the laser from the laser tracking head on at least one of the first to sixth TC reflectors (228106). The method 227100 may further include reflecting the laser from the laser tracking head within a reflective orientation coverage (ROC) map corresponding to a 1.5 plane prism model (228108). In the method 227100, the seventh TC reflector may include a reflective surface that is parallel to a top surface of the mounting cap. In the method 227100, the first to sixth TC reflectors, among the first to seventh TC reflectors, are arranged annularly between the seventh TC reflector and the mounting cap. In the method 227100, for each of the first to third TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, may directly contact the top surface of the mounting cap, and for each of the fourth to sixth TC reflectors, a first side edge, among the three side edges, may directly contact a side edge of the seventh TC reflector.

[00486] Traditional RTS prisms already utilize TC reflectors and may be configured or modified in an embodiment to enhance its resultant ROC map. A complete ROC coverage map can be created, when normal to a surface, by replacing a mounting cap with an additional TC reflector on a 360° prism design. This relatively small design change creates a profound difference in the ROC map. It ensures that, as long as there is a line-of-sight between a laser tracking head and a 1.5 plane prism on a robot crawler, which is normal to some surface, there will also be a line-of-sight with a reflector on the 1.5 plane prism, e.g., the RTS prism 224100. When crawling on assets with curves, or other changing geometries, such as on/in the hull of a ship or in/on a pipe, the RTS prism 224100 remains inside the bounds of its resultant ROC coverage map 225102. It should be appreciated that the aforementioned hull of a ship and pipe locations are non-limiting examples. In a calibration operation, three RTS prisms, e.g., the RTS prism 224100, may be placed on the body 226104 of the inspection robot 226102 at specific locations. The specification locations may be pre-identified in the manufacturing of the body. A laser tracking head at a fixed location, e.g., at a base station, may emit a laser at the three prisms to determine exact locations of each prism with respect to the laser tracking head, e.g., with global position system (GPS) location information. This may provide a triangulated position for the prisms as reference points with respect to the base station. It should be appreciated that embodiments are not limited to three prisms for calibration, and that any number may be used to provide appropriately accurate location calibration. Other location information sources may also be used. During operation, after calibration, only a single prism, e.g., the RTS prism 224100, may be retained on the body 226104 of the inspection robot 226102. Alternatively, the additional calibration prisms may remain in place during operation. It should also be appreciated that calibration may be performed on the inspection robot or on an asset to be mapped by the inspection robot, or next to the asset to be mapped. The ROC map may also be created by mounting a laser tracking head on the inspection robot while the RTS prism 224100 remains at a fixed location, e.g., at a base station. Calibration would still be performed similarly to the above description.

[00487] Advantages and benefits of embodiments may include the improved ROC map that provides an additional 0.5 plane of visibility. Also, embodiments may provide an improved return signal geometry, which may provide a stronger signal. Because embodiments include only the single mounting cap 226108 (see FIG. 94), rather than the two mounting caps 222114, 222116 of the traditional 360° RTS prism 222100 (see FIG. 90), the RTS prism 224100 of FIG. 92 may be manufactured to be smaller than the traditional 360° RTS prism 222100, which may reduce costs and allow for the inspection robot 226102 be made smaller, e.g., to fit into smaller or tighter spaces than with the traditional RTS prism. One reason is that the mounting caps are relatively large with respect to the prism assembly.

[00488] It can be seen that various embodiments herein provide for an inspection robot capable to inspect a surface such as an interior of a pipe and/or an interior of a tank. Additionally, embodiments of an inspection robot herein are operable at elevated temperatures relative to acceptable temperatures for personnel, and operable in composition environments (e.g., presence of CO2, low oxygen, etc.) that are not acceptable to personnel. Additionally, in certain embodiments, entrance of an inspection robot into certain spaces may be a trivial operation, where entrance of a person into the space may require exposure to risk, and/or require extensive preparation and verification (e.g., lock- out/tag-out procedures, confined space procedures, exposure to height procedures, etc.).

Accordingly, embodiments throughout the present disclosure provide for improved cost, safety, capability, and/or completion time of inspections relative to previously known systems or procedures.

[00489] While the disclosure has been disclosed in connection with the preferred embodiments shown and described in detail, various modifications and improvements thereon will become readily apparent to those skilled in the art. Accordingly, the spirit and scope of the present disclosure is not to be limited by the foregoing examples, but is to be understood in the broadest sense allowable by law.

[00490] The use of the terms “a” and “an” and “the” and similar referents in the context of describing the disclosure (especially in the context of the following claims) is to be construed to cover both the singular and the plural, unless otherwise indicated herein or clearly contradicted by context. The terms “comprising,” “having,” “including,” and “containing” are to be construed as open-ended terms (e.g., meaning “including, but not limited to,”) unless otherwise noted. Recitation of ranges of values herein are merely intended to serve as a shorthand method of referring individually to each separate value falling within the range, unless otherwise indicated herein, and each separate value is incorporated into the specification as if it were individually recited herein. All methods described herein can be performed in any suitable order unless otherwise indicated herein or otherwise clearly contradicted by context. The use of any and all examples, or exemplary language (e.g., “such as”) provided herein, is intended merely to better illuminate the disclosure and does not pose a limitation on the scope of the disclosure unless otherwise claimed. The term “set” may include a set with a single member. No language in the specification should be construed as indicating any non-claimed element as essential to the practice of the disclosure.

[00491] While the foregoing written description enables one of ordinary skill to make and use what is considered presently to be the best mode thereof, those of ordinary skill will understand and appreciate the existence of variations, combinations, and equivalents of the specific embodiment, method, and examples herein. The disclosure should therefore not be limited by the above described embodiment, method, and examples, but by all embodiments and methods within the scope and spirit of the disclosure.